1 . $Cambridge: exim/doc/doc-docbook/spec.xfpt,v 1.88 2010/06/14 18:51:09 pdp Exp $
3 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
5 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
6 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
7 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
9 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
10 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
11 . unwanted vertical space.
12 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
19 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
25 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
26 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
28 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
33 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
34 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
35 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
41 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
45 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
46 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
47 . the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
48 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
50 .set previousversion "4.71"
53 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
54 .set I " "
57 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
58 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
59 . provided in the xfpt library.
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
67 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
70 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
72 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
73 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
74 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
84 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
85 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
89 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
90 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
91 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
94 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
97 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
98 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
99 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
103 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
107 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
115 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
116 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
117 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
118 . --- ID that ties them together.
121 &<indexterm role="concept">&
122 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
130 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
131 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
139 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
143 &<indexterm role="option">&
144 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
152 &<indexterm role="variable">&
153 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
161 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
173 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
174 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
175 <date>29 May 2010</date>
176 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
177 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
178 <revhistory><revision>
179 <revnumber>4.72</revnumber>
180 <date>29 May 2010</date>
181 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
182 </revision></revhistory>
183 <copyright><year>2009</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
189 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
190 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
191 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
194 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
197 <indexterm role="variable">
198 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
199 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
201 <indexterm role="concept">
202 <primary>address</primary>
203 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
204 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
206 <indexterm role="concept">
207 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
208 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>CR character</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CRL</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>delivery</primary>
224 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
225 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
227 <indexterm role="concept">
228 <primary>dialup</primary>
229 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>exiscan</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>failover</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>fallover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>filter</primary>
245 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
246 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
248 <indexterm role="concept">
249 <primary>ident</primary>
250 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>LF character</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>maximum</primary>
258 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>monitor</primary>
262 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
266 <see>entry for xxx</see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>NUL</primary>
270 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>passwd file</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>process id</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>RBL</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>redirection</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>return path</primary>
290 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>scanning</primary>
294 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>SSL</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>string</primary>
302 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
303 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
305 <indexterm role="concept">
306 <primary>top bit</primary>
307 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>variables</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
321 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
322 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
323 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
324 . chapter "Introduction"
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
327 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
328 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
329 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
330 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
332 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
333 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
334 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
335 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
336 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
337 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
338 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
340 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
341 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
342 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
344 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
345 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
346 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
348 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
349 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
350 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
351 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
352 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
354 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
355 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
356 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
357 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
358 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
360 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
361 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
362 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
363 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
367 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
368 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
370 .cindex "documentation"
371 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
372 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
373 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
374 capable of showing a change indicator.
377 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
378 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
379 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
380 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
381 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
382 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
383 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
386 .cindex "books about Exim"
387 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
388 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
389 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
390 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
392 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
393 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
394 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
395 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
397 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
398 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
399 Debian-specific features in the file
400 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
401 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
404 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
405 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
407 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
408 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
409 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
410 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
411 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
413 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
414 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
415 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
416 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
418 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
419 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
421 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
422 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
423 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
427 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
428 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
429 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
430 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
431 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
432 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
433 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
436 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
437 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
438 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
442 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
445 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
446 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
447 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
448 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
449 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
450 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
454 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
455 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
456 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
457 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
458 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
461 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
462 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
463 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
467 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
468 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
469 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
472 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
473 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
474 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
475 .row &'exim-future@exim.org'& "Discussion of long-term development"
478 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
479 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
480 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
481 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
482 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
485 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
487 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
490 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
491 .cindex "training courses"
492 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
493 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
494 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
495 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
497 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
498 .cindex "bug reports"
499 .cindex "reporting bugs"
500 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
501 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
502 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
503 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
507 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
509 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
510 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
512 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
516 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
518 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
519 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
520 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
522 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
523 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
524 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
525 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
528 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
530 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
531 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
532 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
534 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
535 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
536 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
537 The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
538 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
539 also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
542 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
543 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
545 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
546 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
547 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
549 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
550 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
551 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
552 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
554 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
555 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
556 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
557 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
559 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
560 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
563 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
565 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
566 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
567 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
568 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
569 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
570 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
571 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
573 .cindex "domainless addresses"
574 .cindex "address" "without domain"
575 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
576 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
577 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
578 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
581 .cindex "transport" "external"
582 .cindex "external transports"
583 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
584 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
585 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
586 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
587 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
588 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
590 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
591 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
592 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
595 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
596 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
597 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
598 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
599 a number of common scanners are provided.
603 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
604 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
605 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
606 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
607 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
608 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
611 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
612 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
613 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
614 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
615 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
616 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
617 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
618 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
619 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
620 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
621 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
622 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
624 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
625 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
626 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
627 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
631 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
632 .cindex "terminology definitions"
633 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
634 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
635 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
636 below) by a blank line.
638 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
639 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
640 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
641 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
642 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
643 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
644 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
645 rise to further bounce messages.
647 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
648 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
649 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
652 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
653 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
654 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
657 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
658 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
659 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
661 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
662 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
663 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
664 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
665 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
666 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
667 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
668 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
670 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
671 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
672 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
673 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
674 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
675 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
678 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
679 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
680 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
681 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
682 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
684 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
685 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
686 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
687 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
688 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
689 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
691 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
692 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
695 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
696 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
697 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
698 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
699 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
701 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
702 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
703 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
704 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
705 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
707 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
708 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
709 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
710 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
711 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
712 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
720 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
722 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
723 .cindex "incorporated code"
724 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
726 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
729 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
730 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
731 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
732 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
733 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
734 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
736 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
737 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
738 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
739 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
740 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
741 following statements:
744 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
746 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
747 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
748 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
750 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
751 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
752 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
753 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
754 restrictions applied to it).
757 .cindex "SPA authentication"
758 .cindex "Samba project"
759 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
760 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
761 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
762 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
766 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
767 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
768 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
769 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
770 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
771 conditions expressed therein.
774 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
776 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
777 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
781 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
782 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
784 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
785 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
786 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
789 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
790 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
791 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
792 details, please contact
794 Office of Technology Transfer
795 Carnegie Mellon University
797 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
798 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
799 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
802 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
805 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
806 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
808 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
809 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
810 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
811 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
812 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
813 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
814 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
819 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
822 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
823 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
824 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
825 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
828 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
829 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
833 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
834 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
835 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
836 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
837 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
838 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
839 software without specific, written prior permission.
841 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
842 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
843 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
844 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
845 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
846 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
851 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
852 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
853 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
861 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
863 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
864 "Receiving and delivering mail"
867 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
868 .cindex "design philosophy"
869 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
870 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
871 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
872 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
873 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
874 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
877 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
878 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
879 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
880 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
881 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
882 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
883 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
886 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
887 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
888 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
889 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
890 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
891 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
892 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
893 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
894 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
897 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
898 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
900 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
901 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
902 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
903 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
905 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
906 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
907 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
908 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
909 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
911 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
912 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
913 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
915 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
916 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
917 runs at the start of every delivery process.
922 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
923 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
924 .cindex "Sieve filter"
925 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
926 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
927 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
928 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
929 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
930 of filtering are available:
933 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
936 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
937 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
940 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
944 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
945 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
946 .cindex "format" "of message id"
947 .cindex "id of message"
952 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
953 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
954 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
955 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
956 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
957 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
958 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
959 not always case-sensitive.
961 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
962 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
963 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
964 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
965 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
966 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
970 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
971 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
972 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
973 way of representing the date and time of day).
975 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
976 received the message.
978 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
980 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
981 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
982 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
983 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
984 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
986 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
987 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
992 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
993 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
994 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
995 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
996 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
999 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1000 .cindex "receiving mail"
1001 .cindex "message" "reception"
1002 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1003 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1004 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1005 there are several possibilities:
1008 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1009 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1010 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1012 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1013 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1014 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1015 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1016 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1017 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1019 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1020 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1021 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1022 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1023 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1025 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1026 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1027 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1028 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1032 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1033 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1034 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1035 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1036 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1037 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1038 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1039 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1040 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1041 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1042 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1043 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1044 users to change sender addresses.
1046 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1047 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1048 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1049 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1050 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1051 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1052 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1054 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1055 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1056 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1057 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1058 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1059 message is received.
1065 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1066 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1067 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1068 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1069 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1070 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1071 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1072 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1074 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1075 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1076 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1077 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1078 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1079 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1080 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1081 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1082 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1083 affect file system performance.
1085 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1086 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1087 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1088 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1089 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1091 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1092 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1093 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1094 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1095 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1096 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1097 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1098 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1099 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1100 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1101 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1102 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1106 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1107 .cindex "message" "life of"
1108 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1109 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1110 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1111 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1112 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1113 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1114 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1116 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1117 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1118 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1119 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1120 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1123 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1124 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1125 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1126 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1127 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1129 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1130 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1131 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1132 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1133 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1134 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1135 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1136 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1137 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1138 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1141 .cindex "journal file"
1142 .cindex "file" "journal"
1143 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1144 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1145 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1146 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1147 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1148 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1149 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1150 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1152 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1153 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1154 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1155 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1156 deliveries caused by crashes.
1160 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1161 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1162 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1163 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1164 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1165 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1166 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1167 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1168 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1170 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1171 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1172 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1173 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1174 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1175 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1176 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1177 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1178 the driver's features in general.
1180 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1181 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1182 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1183 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1186 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1187 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1188 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1189 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1190 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1191 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1193 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1194 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1195 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1196 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1197 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1198 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1200 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1201 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1202 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1205 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1206 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1207 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1208 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1209 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1210 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1211 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1212 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1213 configured to fail the address.
1215 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1216 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1217 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1218 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1219 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1220 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1222 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1223 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1224 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1225 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1226 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1227 the address is bounced.
1231 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1232 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1233 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1234 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1235 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1236 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1237 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1238 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1240 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1241 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1242 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1243 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1244 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1245 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1246 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1247 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1252 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1253 .cindex "router" "running details"
1254 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1255 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1256 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1257 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1258 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1259 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1263 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1264 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1265 original address ceases,
1266 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1267 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1268 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1269 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1270 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1273 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1274 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1275 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1276 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1277 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1279 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1280 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1281 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1282 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1283 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1285 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1286 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1287 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1288 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1289 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1291 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1292 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1293 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1295 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1296 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1297 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1298 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1300 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1301 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1304 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1305 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1306 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1307 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1308 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1310 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1311 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1312 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1313 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1314 facility for this purpose.
1317 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1318 .cindex "case of local parts"
1319 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1320 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1321 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1322 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1323 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1324 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1325 routed addresses are shown.
1329 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1330 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1331 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1332 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1333 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1334 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1337 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1338 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1339 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1340 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1341 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1342 of any other conditions.
1344 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1345 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1346 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1348 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1349 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1350 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1351 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1353 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1354 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1355 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1356 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1357 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1359 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1360 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1362 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1363 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1365 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1366 of domains that it defines.
1368 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1369 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1370 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1371 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1372 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1373 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1374 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1375 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1376 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1377 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1379 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1380 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1382 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1383 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1384 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1385 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1386 remaining preconditions.
1388 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1389 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1390 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1391 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1392 could lead to confusion.
1394 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1395 set of addresses that it defines.
1397 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1398 specified files is tested.
1400 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1401 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1402 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1403 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1407 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1408 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1409 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1410 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1411 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1412 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1413 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1417 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1418 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1419 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1422 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1423 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1424 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1425 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1426 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1428 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1429 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1431 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1432 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1433 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1434 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1435 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1436 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1439 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1440 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1441 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1442 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1443 processed entirely independently of each other.
1445 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1446 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1447 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1448 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1449 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1450 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1451 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1452 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1453 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1455 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1456 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1457 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1458 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1459 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1460 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1461 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1462 addresses to the same domain.
1464 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1465 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1466 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1467 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1468 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1469 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1470 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1471 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1473 .cindex "queue runner"
1474 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1475 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1476 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1477 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1478 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1479 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1480 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1481 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1482 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1484 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1485 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1486 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1487 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1488 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1489 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1491 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1492 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1493 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1494 messages to other addresses.
1496 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1497 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1498 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1501 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1502 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1503 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1509 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1510 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1511 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1512 .cindex "queue runner"
1513 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1514 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1515 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1516 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1517 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1518 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1519 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1520 passed its retry time.
1521 You can run several queue runners at once.
1523 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1524 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1525 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1526 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1527 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1532 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1533 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1534 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1535 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1536 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1537 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1538 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1539 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1540 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1543 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1544 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1545 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1548 .cindex "hints database"
1549 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1550 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1551 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1552 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1558 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1559 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1560 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1561 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1562 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1563 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1564 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1565 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1566 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1567 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1568 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1570 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1571 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1572 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1575 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1576 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1577 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1578 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1579 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1580 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1581 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1586 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1587 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1588 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1589 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1590 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1591 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1592 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1593 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1599 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1600 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1602 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1603 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1605 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1606 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1607 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1608 &_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1611 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1612 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1614 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1615 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1616 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1617 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1621 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1622 following subdirectories are created:
1625 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1626 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1627 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1628 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1629 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1630 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1631 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1634 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1635 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1636 that may be useful to some sites.
1639 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1640 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1641 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1642 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1643 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1644 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1646 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1647 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1648 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1649 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1650 overridden if necessary.
1653 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1654 .cindex "PCRE library"
1655 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1656 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1657 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1658 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1659 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1660 headers are in an unusual location you will need to set the PCRE_LIBS
1661 and INCLUDE directives appropriately. If your operating system has no
1662 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1663 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1665 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1666 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1667 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1668 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1669 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1670 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1671 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1673 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1674 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1675 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1676 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1677 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1678 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1679 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1680 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1682 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1683 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1684 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1685 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1686 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1687 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1688 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1689 Berkeley DB library.
1691 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1692 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1696 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1697 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1699 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1700 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1701 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1702 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1703 file name is used unmodified.
1705 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1706 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1707 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1708 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1710 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1711 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1712 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1714 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1715 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1716 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1717 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1718 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1719 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1721 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1722 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1723 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1724 operates on a single file.
1728 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1729 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1730 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1731 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1732 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1736 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1737 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1739 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1740 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1741 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1742 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1743 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1744 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1746 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1747 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1748 in one of these lines:
1753 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1754 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1755 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1756 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1759 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1760 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1762 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1763 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1767 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1768 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1769 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1770 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1771 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1772 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1773 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1774 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1775 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1776 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1777 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1778 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1780 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1781 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1782 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1783 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1784 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1785 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1787 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1788 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1789 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1790 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1791 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1792 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1795 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1796 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1797 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1798 facilities, you need to set
1800 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1802 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1803 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1806 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1807 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1808 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1809 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1810 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1811 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1812 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1814 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1815 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1816 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1817 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1818 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1823 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1824 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1826 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1827 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1828 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1829 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1830 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1831 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1832 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1834 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1835 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1836 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1837 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1838 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1842 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1846 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1847 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1848 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1849 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1850 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1851 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1852 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1853 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1854 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1855 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1858 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1859 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1862 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1865 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1867 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1868 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1871 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1872 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1874 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1875 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1879 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1881 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1882 library and include files. For example:
1886 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1887 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1889 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1890 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1891 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1896 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1897 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1898 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1899 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1900 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1901 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1902 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1903 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1904 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1905 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1906 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1907 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1908 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1911 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1912 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1913 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1915 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1916 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1918 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1920 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1921 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1922 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1923 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1924 in &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1925 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1930 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1931 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1932 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1933 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1934 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1935 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1938 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1939 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1940 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1941 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1942 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1943 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1944 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1945 support has not been tested for some time.
1949 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
1950 .cindex "build directory"
1951 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
1952 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
1953 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
1954 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
1955 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
1956 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
1957 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
1959 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
1960 building process fails if it is set.
1962 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
1963 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
1964 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
1965 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
1966 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
1967 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
1968 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
1969 directory, should this ever be necessary.
1971 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
1972 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
1973 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
1977 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
1978 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
1979 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
1980 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
1981 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
1982 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
1983 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
1987 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
1988 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
1989 given in addition to the short output.
1993 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
1994 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
1995 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
1996 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
1997 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
1998 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
1999 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2002 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2003 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2005 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2006 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2007 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2008 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2010 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2011 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2012 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2013 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2014 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2015 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2016 and are often not needed.
2018 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2019 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2020 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2021 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2022 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2023 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2024 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2025 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2026 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2029 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2030 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2031 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2032 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2036 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2037 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2038 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2039 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2040 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2041 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2042 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2043 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2044 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2045 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2046 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2047 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2048 containing the lines
2053 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2054 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2056 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2057 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2058 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2061 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2062 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2063 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2064 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2065 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2066 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2067 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2068 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2069 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2070 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2076 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2077 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2078 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2079 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2080 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2081 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2082 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2083 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2086 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2087 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2088 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2092 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2093 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2095 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2096 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2097 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2098 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2099 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2100 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2103 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2104 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2106 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2107 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2110 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2111 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2113 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2114 definition of all three of these variables into your
2115 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2118 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2119 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2120 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2121 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2123 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2124 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2125 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2126 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2127 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2130 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2131 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2132 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2133 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2134 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2137 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2139 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2140 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2141 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2142 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2143 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2144 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2148 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2149 .cindex "building Eximon"
2150 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2151 where the files that are involved are
2153 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2154 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2155 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2156 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2157 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2158 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2160 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2161 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2162 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2163 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2164 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2165 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2166 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2170 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2171 .cindex "installing Exim"
2172 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2173 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2174 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2175 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2176 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2177 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2178 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2179 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2180 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2181 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2182 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2183 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2185 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2186 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2187 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2188 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2189 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2190 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2191 alternative files, no default is installed.
2193 .cindex "system aliases file"
2194 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2195 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2196 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2197 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2198 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2199 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2200 and outputs a comment to the user.
2202 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2203 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2204 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2205 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2206 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2208 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2209 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2210 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2211 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2212 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2215 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2216 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2219 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2221 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2222 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2223 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2224 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2225 but this usage is deprecated.
2227 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2228 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2229 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2230 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2231 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2232 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2234 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2235 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2236 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2237 for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2238 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2239 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2240 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2242 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2243 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2244 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2247 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2249 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2250 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2251 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2252 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2255 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2257 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2258 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2261 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2262 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2264 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2268 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2270 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2272 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2273 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2274 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2276 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2281 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2282 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2283 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2284 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2285 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2288 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2289 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2290 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2294 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2295 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2296 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2297 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2298 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2304 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2305 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2306 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2307 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2308 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2312 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2313 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2314 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2315 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2316 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2319 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2321 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2323 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2325 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2326 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2327 user agent. For example:
2329 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2330 From: user@your.domain.example
2331 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2332 Subject: Testing Exim
2334 This is a test message.
2337 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2338 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2339 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2341 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2342 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2343 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2344 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2345 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2346 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2348 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2350 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2351 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2352 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2353 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2354 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2356 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2357 .cindex "lock files"
2358 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2359 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2360 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2361 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2362 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2363 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2364 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2365 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2366 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2367 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2368 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2369 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2371 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2372 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2373 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2374 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2375 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2378 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2379 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2380 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2381 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2385 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2386 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2387 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2388 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2389 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2390 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2391 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2392 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2393 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2394 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2395 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2396 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2397 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2399 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2400 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2401 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2402 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2403 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2404 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2407 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2408 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2409 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2410 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2412 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2413 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2414 favourite user agent.
2416 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2417 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2418 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2419 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2420 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2421 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2425 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2426 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2427 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2428 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2429 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2430 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2431 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2432 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2438 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2439 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2440 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2442 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2444 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2445 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2446 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2447 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2448 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2450 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2452 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2454 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2455 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2456 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2461 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2462 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2464 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2465 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2466 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2467 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2468 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2469 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2470 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2471 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2472 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2475 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2477 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2478 were present before any other options.
2479 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2481 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2482 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2483 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2486 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2487 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2488 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2492 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2493 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2494 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2497 .cindex "queue runner"
2498 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2499 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2500 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2502 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2503 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2504 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2505 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2506 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2507 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2508 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2509 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2512 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2513 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2514 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2515 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2516 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2517 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2520 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2521 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2522 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2523 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2524 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2525 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2527 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2528 .cindex "envelope sender"
2529 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2530 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2531 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2532 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2533 users to set envelope senders.
2535 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2536 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2537 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2538 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2539 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2541 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2542 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2543 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2544 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2545 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2546 that are available to trusted users.
2548 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2549 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2550 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2551 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2552 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2554 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2555 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2556 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2557 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2559 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2560 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2561 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2562 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2564 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2565 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2570 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2571 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2572 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2578 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2579 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2580 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2581 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2582 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2583 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2584 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2585 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2587 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2588 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2589 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2590 . creates a man page for the options.
2591 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2594 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2601 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2602 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2603 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2604 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2607 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2608 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2609 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2612 .vitem &%--version%&
2613 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2614 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2617 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2619 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2620 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2621 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2622 clean; it ignores this option.
2627 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2628 .cindex "queue runner"
2629 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2630 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2631 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2633 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2634 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2635 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2636 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2638 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2639 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2640 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2641 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2643 When a listening daemon
2644 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2645 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2646 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2647 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2648 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2649 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2652 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2653 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2654 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2658 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2659 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2660 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2661 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2662 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2663 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2664 because these are reread each time they are used.
2668 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2669 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2673 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2674 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2675 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2676 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2677 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2678 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2680 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2681 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2682 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2683 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2684 test data. A line history is supported.
2686 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2687 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2688 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2689 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2690 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2691 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2692 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2694 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2695 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2696 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2697 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2699 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2701 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2702 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2703 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2704 of a file. For example:
2706 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2708 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2709 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2710 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2711 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2712 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2713 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2714 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2717 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2719 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2720 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2721 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2722 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2723 system filters are recognized.
2725 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2727 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2728 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2729 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2730 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2731 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2732 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2733 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2734 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2737 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2738 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2739 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2741 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2743 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2744 variables that are used by the user filter.
2746 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2751 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2752 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2753 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2756 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2757 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2758 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2759 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2761 When testing a filter file,
2762 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2763 .cindex "envelope sender"
2764 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2765 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2766 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2767 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2768 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2771 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2773 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2774 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2775 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2778 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2780 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2781 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2782 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2783 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2784 actually being delivered.
2786 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2788 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2789 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2792 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2794 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2795 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2798 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2800 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2801 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2802 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2803 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2804 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2805 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2806 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2807 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2808 after a full stop. For example:
2810 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2811 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2813 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2814 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2815 conversion to the canonical form is
2816 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2818 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2819 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2820 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2821 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2822 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2826 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2827 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2828 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2831 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2832 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2833 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2835 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2836 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2837 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2838 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2839 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2840 session were authenticated.
2842 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2843 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2844 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2846 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2847 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2848 specialized SMTP test program such as
2849 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2851 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2853 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2854 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2855 updating the callout cache database.
2859 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2860 .cindex "building alias file"
2861 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2862 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2863 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2864 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2865 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2868 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2869 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2870 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2871 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2872 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2873 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2878 .cindex "local message reception"
2879 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2880 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2881 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2882 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2883 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2884 if no other conflicting option is present.
2886 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2887 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2888 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2889 suppressing this for special cases.
2891 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2892 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2894 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2895 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2896 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
2899 .cindex "message" "format"
2900 .cindex "format" "message"
2901 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2902 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
2903 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
2904 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2905 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2907 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2908 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2910 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2911 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2912 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2913 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
2914 option, which can be changed if necessary.
2916 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
2917 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2918 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
2919 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2920 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2924 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
2925 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
2926 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
2927 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
2928 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
2929 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
2930 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
2932 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
2933 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
2934 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
2935 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
2936 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
2938 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
2939 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
2940 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
2941 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
2946 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
2947 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
2948 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
2949 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
2950 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
2951 arguments, for example:
2953 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
2955 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
2956 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
2957 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
2958 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
2959 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
2960 users, the output is as in this example:
2962 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
2964 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
2965 configuration file is output.
2966 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
2967 is the name of the file that was actually used.
2969 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2970 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2971 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
2972 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
2973 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
2974 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
2975 written directly into the spool directory.
2977 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
2979 exim -bP +local_domains
2981 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
2982 local part) and outputs what it finds.
2984 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
2985 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
2986 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
2987 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
2988 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
2989 that driver are output. For example:
2991 exim -bP transport local_delivery
2993 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
2994 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
2995 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
2996 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
2997 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3000 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3001 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3002 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3003 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3004 The output format is one item per line.
3008 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3009 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3010 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3011 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3012 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3013 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3014 to allow any user to see the queue.
3016 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3018 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3019 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3022 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3023 .cindex "size" "of message"
3024 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3025 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3026 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3027 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3028 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3029 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3030 before the sender address.
3032 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3033 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3034 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3036 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3037 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3038 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3039 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3040 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3046 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3047 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3048 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3054 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3055 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3056 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3057 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3062 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3063 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3064 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3065 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3069 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3073 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3078 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3079 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3080 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3081 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3086 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3087 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3088 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3089 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3090 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3092 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3093 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3095 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3096 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3097 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3098 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3099 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3100 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3101 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3102 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3103 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3105 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3106 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3111 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3112 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3113 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3114 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3115 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3116 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3117 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3121 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3122 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3123 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3124 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3125 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3126 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3127 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3128 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3129 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3131 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3132 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3133 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3135 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3136 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3137 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3138 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3140 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3141 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3142 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3144 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3145 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3146 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3147 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3148 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3150 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3151 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3155 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3156 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3157 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3158 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3159 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3160 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3161 messages to the MTA.
3164 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3165 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3166 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3167 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3168 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3169 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3170 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3174 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3175 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3176 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3177 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3178 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3179 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3180 the listening daemon.
3182 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3183 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3184 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3185 .cindex "malware scan test"
3186 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3187 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3188 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3189 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3190 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3191 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3193 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3194 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3195 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3196 This option requires admin privileges.
3198 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3199 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3200 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3204 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3205 .cindex "address" "testing"
3206 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3207 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3208 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3209 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3210 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3212 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3213 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3215 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3216 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3219 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3220 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3221 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3222 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3223 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3226 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3227 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3228 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3229 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3231 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3232 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3233 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3234 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3237 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3238 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3240 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3241 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3242 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3243 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3244 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3245 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3250 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3251 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3252 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3253 It also lists the DBM library this is being used, the optional modules (such as
3254 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3255 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3257 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3258 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3259 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3260 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3261 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3262 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3263 dynamic testing facilities.
3267 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3268 .cindex "address" "verification"
3269 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3270 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3271 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3272 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3273 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3274 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3276 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3277 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3278 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3280 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3281 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3283 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3284 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3287 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3288 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3289 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3290 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3291 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3293 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3294 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3295 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3296 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3297 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3298 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3301 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3302 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3303 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3306 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3307 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3308 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3309 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3311 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3312 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3313 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3314 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3318 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3319 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3322 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3324 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3325 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3326 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3327 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3328 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3329 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3330 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3331 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3332 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3334 When this option is used by a caller other than root or the Exim user, and the
3335 list is different from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege
3336 immediately, and runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of
3337 the caller. However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in
3338 &_Local/Makefile_&, root privilege is retained for &%-C%& only if the caller of
3341 That is, the Exim user is no longer privileged in this regard. This build-time
3342 option is not set by default in the Exim source distribution tarbundle.
3343 However, if you are using a &"packaged"& version of Exim (source or binary),
3344 the packagers might have enabled it.
3346 Setting ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY locks out the possibility of testing a
3347 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
3348 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
3349 as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the delivery,
3350 the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception
3351 and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue,
3352 using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3354 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3355 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3356 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3357 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3358 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3359 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3360 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3362 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3363 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3364 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3367 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3368 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3369 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3370 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3371 specified by this option.
3373 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3375 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3376 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3377 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3378 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3379 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3380 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3382 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3383 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3384 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3390 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3391 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3394 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3396 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3398 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3400 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3401 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3402 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3403 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3404 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3405 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3406 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3409 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3410 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3411 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3412 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3413 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3414 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3415 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3418 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3419 &`auth `& authenticators
3420 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3421 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3422 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3423 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3424 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3425 &`filter `& filter handling
3426 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3427 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3428 &`ident `& ident lookup
3429 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3430 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3431 &`load `& system load checks
3432 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3433 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3434 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3435 &`memory `& memory handling
3436 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3437 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3438 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3439 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3440 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3441 &`retry `& retry handling
3442 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3443 &`route `& address routing
3444 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3446 &`transport `& transports
3447 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3448 &`verify `& address verification logic
3449 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3451 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3452 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3453 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3454 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3455 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3456 turn everything off.
3458 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3459 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3460 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3461 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3462 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3465 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3466 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3467 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3468 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3469 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3472 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3473 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3476 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3477 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3479 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3481 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3482 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3483 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3484 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3487 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3488 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3489 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3490 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3494 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3495 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3496 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3497 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3498 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3499 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3500 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3501 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3504 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3505 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3506 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3507 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3508 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3510 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3512 .cindex "sender" "name"
3513 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3514 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3515 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3516 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3517 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3518 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3520 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3522 .cindex "sender" "address"
3523 .cindex "address" "sender"
3524 .cindex "trusted users"
3525 .cindex "envelope sender"
3526 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3527 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3528 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3529 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3532 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3533 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3534 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3535 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3538 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3539 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3540 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3541 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3542 examples of shell commands:
3544 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3545 exim -f "" user@domain
3547 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3548 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3551 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3552 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3553 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3554 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3557 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3558 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3559 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3560 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3561 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3562 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3566 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-G%& option ignored"
3567 This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3569 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3571 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3572 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3573 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3578 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3579 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3580 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3581 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3582 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3583 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3585 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3587 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3588 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3589 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3590 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3591 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3592 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3593 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3596 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3597 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3598 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3599 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3600 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3601 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3603 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3604 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3605 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3606 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3608 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3610 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3611 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3612 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3613 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3614 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3615 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3616 can be used only by an admin user.
3618 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3619 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3621 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3622 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3623 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3624 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3625 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3626 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3627 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3628 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3632 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3633 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3634 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3638 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3639 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3640 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3642 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3644 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3645 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3646 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3647 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3648 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3649 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3653 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3654 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3655 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3660 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3661 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3662 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3664 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3666 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3667 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3668 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3669 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3670 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3671 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3672 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3673 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3674 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3675 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3676 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3677 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3678 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3680 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3682 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3683 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3684 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3685 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3686 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3687 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3688 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3689 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3691 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3693 .cindex "freezing messages"
3694 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3695 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3696 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3697 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3698 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3699 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3702 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3704 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3705 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3706 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3707 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3708 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3709 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3710 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3711 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3714 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3716 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3717 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3718 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3719 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3720 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3722 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3724 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3725 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3726 .cindex "removing recipients"
3727 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3728 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3729 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3730 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3731 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3732 can be used only by an admin user.
3734 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3736 .cindex "removing messages"
3737 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3738 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3739 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3740 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3741 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3742 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3743 placed on the queue.
3745 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3747 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3748 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3749 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3750 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3751 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3752 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3753 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3754 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3755 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3757 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3759 .cindex "thawing messages"
3760 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3761 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3762 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3763 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3764 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3765 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3768 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3770 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3771 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3772 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3773 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3775 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3777 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3778 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3779 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3780 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3781 only by an admin user.
3783 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3785 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3786 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3787 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3788 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3789 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3791 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3793 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3794 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3795 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3796 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3800 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3801 treats it that way too.
3805 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3806 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3807 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3808 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3809 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3810 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3811 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3814 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3815 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3816 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3817 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3818 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3819 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3820 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3825 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-n%& option ignored"
3826 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&. It is ignored
3829 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3831 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3834 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3836 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3837 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3838 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3841 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3843 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3844 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3845 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3846 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3847 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
3848 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3852 .cindex "background delivery"
3853 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
3854 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3855 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
3856 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3857 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3858 processes to finish.
3860 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
3861 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
3862 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3863 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
3865 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3866 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
3867 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
3868 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
3872 .cindex "foreground delivery"
3873 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
3874 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
3875 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3876 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
3877 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3879 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3880 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3883 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
3884 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3886 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
3887 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
3888 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
3889 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
3894 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
3899 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
3900 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
3901 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
3902 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3903 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
3904 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
3905 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
3906 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
3907 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
3908 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
3913 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
3914 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
3915 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
3916 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
3917 configuration file is in effect.
3919 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
3920 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
3921 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
3922 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
3923 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
3924 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
3925 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
3926 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
3927 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
3932 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3933 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
3934 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
3937 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
3939 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
3940 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
3941 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
3942 the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3946 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3947 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
3948 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
3949 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
3950 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3954 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3955 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
3956 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
3957 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
3958 The return code is 1 for all errors.
3962 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3963 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3968 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3969 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3974 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3975 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
3976 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
3977 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
3978 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
3979 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
3982 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
3983 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
3985 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
3987 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
3988 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
3989 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
3990 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
3991 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
3992 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
3994 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
3995 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
3997 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
3999 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4000 followed by a colon and the port number:
4002 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4004 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4005 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4006 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4007 whichever one is last.
4009 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4011 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4012 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4013 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4014 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4015 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4016 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4018 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4020 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4021 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4022 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4023 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4024 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4025 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4027 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4029 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4030 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4031 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4032 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4033 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4034 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4035 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4036 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4038 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4040 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4041 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4042 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4043 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4044 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4046 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4048 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4049 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4050 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4051 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4052 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4053 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4054 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4055 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4056 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4059 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4061 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4062 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4063 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4064 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4065 uses the name it is given.
4067 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4069 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4070 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4071 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4072 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4073 used, when there is no default.
4077 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4078 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4079 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4080 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4084 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4085 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4086 whatever that means.
4088 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4090 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4091 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4092 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4093 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4094 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4095 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4096 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4098 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4100 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4101 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4102 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4103 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4104 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4106 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4108 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4109 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4110 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4111 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4112 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4113 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4117 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4119 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4121 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4122 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4123 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4124 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4125 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4126 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4127 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4128 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4132 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4133 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4134 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4135 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4140 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4141 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4142 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4143 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4146 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4148 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4150 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4152 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4153 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4154 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4155 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4156 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4160 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4161 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4162 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4163 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4164 and &%-S%& options).
4166 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4167 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4168 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4169 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4170 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4171 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4174 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4175 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4176 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4177 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4178 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4181 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4182 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4183 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4184 this to be repeated periodically.
4186 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4187 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4188 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4189 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4191 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4192 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4193 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4195 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4196 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4197 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4198 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4202 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4203 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4204 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4205 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4206 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4207 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4210 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4211 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4212 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4213 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4214 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4215 delivered down a single SMTP
4216 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4217 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4218 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4219 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4220 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4223 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4225 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4226 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4227 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4228 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4229 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4231 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4233 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4234 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4235 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4236 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4237 their retry times are tried.
4239 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4241 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4242 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4245 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4247 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4248 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4249 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4252 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4253 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4254 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4255 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4256 starting message id. For example:
4258 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4260 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4261 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4262 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4264 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4266 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4267 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4268 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4269 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4270 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4271 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4273 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4274 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4275 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4276 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4277 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4278 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4279 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4280 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4281 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4283 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4285 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4286 process every 30 minutes.
4288 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4289 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4291 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4293 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4296 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4298 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4300 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4302 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4303 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4304 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4305 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4306 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4307 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4308 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4310 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4311 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4312 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4313 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4314 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4315 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4317 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4318 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4320 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4322 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4323 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4324 applied to each queue run.
4326 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4327 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4328 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4329 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4330 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4331 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4332 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4333 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4334 address will be skipped.
4336 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4337 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4338 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4341 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4342 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4343 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4344 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4345 an arbitrary command instead.
4349 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4351 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4353 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4354 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4355 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4356 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4357 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4358 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4360 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4362 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4363 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4364 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4368 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4369 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4370 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4371 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4372 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4373 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4374 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4375 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4376 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4378 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4379 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4380 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4381 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4382 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4383 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4384 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4385 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4386 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4387 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4388 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4390 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4391 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4392 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4393 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4394 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4395 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4397 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4398 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4399 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4400 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4401 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4402 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4403 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4404 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4405 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4409 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4410 compatibility with Sendmail.
4412 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4413 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4414 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4415 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4416 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4417 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4418 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4419 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4424 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4425 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4426 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4427 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4428 set. Exim ignores this option.
4432 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4433 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4434 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4435 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4436 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4437 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4442 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4443 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4444 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4452 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4453 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4454 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4455 . creates a man page for the options.
4456 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4459 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4466 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4467 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4470 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4471 "The runtime configuration file"
4473 .cindex "run time configuration"
4474 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4475 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4476 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4477 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4478 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4479 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4480 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4481 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4484 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4485 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4486 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4487 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4488 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4489 actually alter the string.
4491 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4492 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4493 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4494 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4495 existing file in the list.
4498 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4499 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4500 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4501 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4502 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4503 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4504 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4505 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4506 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4507 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4509 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4510 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4511 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4512 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4513 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4515 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4516 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4517 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4518 compromise the Exim user account.
4520 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4521 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4522 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4523 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4524 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4525 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4530 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4531 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4532 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4533 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4534 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root or the
4535 Exim user (or unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value
4536 from CONFIGURE_FILE). &%-C%& is useful mainly for checking the syntax of
4537 configuration files before installing them. No owner or group checks are done
4538 on a configuration file specified by &%-C%&.
4540 The privileged use of &%-C%& by the Exim user can be locked out by setting
4541 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. However,
4542 if you do this, you also lock out the possibility of testing a
4543 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
4544 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
4545 as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the
4546 use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and
4547 delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue, using
4548 &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
4550 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4551 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4552 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4553 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4554 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4556 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4557 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4558 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4559 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4560 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4561 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4563 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4564 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4565 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4566 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4567 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4568 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4569 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4571 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4572 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4573 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4577 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4578 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4579 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4580 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4581 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4582 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4583 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4587 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4590 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4591 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4592 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4594 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4595 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4596 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4598 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4599 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4600 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4602 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4603 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4604 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4605 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4608 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4609 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4610 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4612 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4613 want to use this feature, you must set
4615 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4617 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4618 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4621 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4622 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4623 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4624 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4626 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4627 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4628 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4629 and does not introduce a comment.
4631 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4632 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4633 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4634 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4635 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4637 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4638 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4639 change settings as required.
4641 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4642 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4643 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4644 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4645 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4650 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4651 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4652 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4653 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4654 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4655 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4658 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4659 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4661 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4662 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4663 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4666 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4667 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4668 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4669 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4671 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4672 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4675 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4678 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4679 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4684 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4685 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4686 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4687 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4688 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4689 definition, and must be of the form
4691 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4693 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4694 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4695 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4696 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4697 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4699 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4700 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4701 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4703 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4704 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4705 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4706 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4707 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4708 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4709 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4712 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4713 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4715 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4716 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4717 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4718 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4719 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4720 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4723 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4724 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4725 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4730 MAC == updated value
4732 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4733 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4734 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4735 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4739 MAC == MAC and something added
4741 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4742 from a number of other files.
4744 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4745 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4746 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4747 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4748 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4753 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4754 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4755 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4756 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4758 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4759 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4761 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4763 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4765 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4766 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4767 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4770 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4771 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4772 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4773 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4774 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4775 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4776 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4778 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4779 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4780 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4784 message_size_limit = 50M
4786 message_size_limit = 100M
4789 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4790 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4791 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4792 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4794 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4795 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4796 in this line"& will always be true.
4798 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4799 to clarify complicated nestings.
4803 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4804 .cindex "common option syntax"
4805 .cindex "syntax of common options"
4806 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4807 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4808 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4809 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4810 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4811 space) and then the value. For example:
4813 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4815 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4816 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4817 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4818 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4819 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4820 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4821 word &"hide"&. For example:
4823 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4825 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4827 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4829 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
4830 all instances of the same driver.
4832 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4833 that are found in option settings.
4836 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
4837 .cindex "format" "boolean"
4838 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
4839 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
4840 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
4841 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4842 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4843 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4844 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
4845 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
4846 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
4847 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4852 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4857 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4862 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
4863 .cindex "integer configuration values"
4864 .cindex "format" "integer"
4865 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
4866 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
4867 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
4868 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
4871 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
4872 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
4873 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
4874 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
4875 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
4879 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
4880 .cindex "integer format"
4881 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
4882 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
4883 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
4884 Such options are always output in octal.
4887 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
4888 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
4889 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
4890 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
4891 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
4895 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
4896 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
4897 .cindex "format" "time interval"
4898 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
4899 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
4909 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
4910 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
4911 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
4915 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
4916 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
4917 .cindex "format" "string"
4918 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
4919 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
4920 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
4921 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
4922 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
4923 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
4924 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
4925 therefore equivalent:
4927 trusted_users = uucp:mail
4928 trusted_users = uucp:\
4929 # This comment line is ignored
4932 .cindex "string" "quoted"
4933 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
4934 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
4935 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
4936 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
4939 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
4940 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
4941 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
4943 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
4944 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
4948 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
4949 character, that character replaces the pair.
4951 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
4952 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
4953 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
4954 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
4955 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
4956 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
4959 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
4960 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
4961 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
4962 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
4963 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
4964 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
4965 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
4966 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
4967 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
4968 within a quoted configuration string.
4971 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
4972 .cindex "user name" "format of"
4973 .cindex "format" "user name"
4974 .cindex "groups" "name format"
4975 .cindex "format" "group name"
4976 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
4977 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
4978 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
4979 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
4982 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
4983 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
4984 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
4985 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
4986 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
4987 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
4988 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
4989 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
4990 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
4991 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
4992 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
4994 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
4995 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
4996 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
4997 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
4998 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
4999 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5002 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5004 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5006 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5007 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5008 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5009 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5011 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5012 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5013 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5014 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5015 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5016 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5017 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5018 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5020 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5022 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5023 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5024 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5026 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5027 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5028 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5029 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5030 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5031 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5032 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5033 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5034 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5036 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5038 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5039 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5040 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5041 the value in quotes. For example:
5043 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5045 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5046 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5047 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5048 enclosing an empty list item.
5052 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5053 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5054 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5055 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5057 senders = user@domain :
5059 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5060 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5061 items, the second of which is empty:
5063 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5065 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5066 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5067 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5068 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5072 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5073 is at the end of the list.
5078 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5079 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5080 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5081 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5082 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5083 a sequence of lines like this:
5085 <&'instance name'&>:
5090 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5091 followed by three options settings:
5096 transport = local_delivery
5098 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5099 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5100 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5101 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5102 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5103 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5105 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5106 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5108 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5109 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5110 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5111 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5112 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5115 .cindex "generic options"
5116 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5117 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5118 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5119 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5120 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5121 .cindex "private options"
5122 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5123 they all have default values.
5125 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5126 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5127 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5129 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5130 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5131 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5132 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5133 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5134 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5135 configuration lines:
5140 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5141 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5142 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5143 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5149 command_timeout = 10s
5151 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5152 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5155 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5156 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5157 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5165 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5168 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5169 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5170 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5171 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5172 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5173 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5174 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5175 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5176 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5177 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5178 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5182 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5183 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5184 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5187 # primary_hostname =
5189 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5190 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5191 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5192 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5194 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5196 domainlist local_domains = @
5197 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5198 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5200 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5201 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5202 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5203 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5205 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5206 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5209 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5210 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5211 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5212 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5213 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5214 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5216 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5217 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5218 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5219 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5220 domain is permitted.
5222 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5223 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5224 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5225 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5226 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5227 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5229 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5230 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5231 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5233 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5235 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5236 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5238 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5239 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5240 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5241 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5242 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5243 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5244 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5245 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5246 contents of a message to be checked.
5248 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5250 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5251 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5253 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5254 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5255 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5256 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5258 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5260 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5261 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5262 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5264 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5265 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5266 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5267 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5268 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5269 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5270 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5272 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5274 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5275 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5277 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5278 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5279 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5280 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5281 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5282 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5283 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5284 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5285 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5286 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5287 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5288 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5289 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5290 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5291 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5292 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5294 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5297 # qualify_recipient =
5299 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5300 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5301 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5302 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5303 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5304 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5306 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5307 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5308 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5309 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5311 # allow_domain_literals
5313 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5314 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5315 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5316 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5317 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5318 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5320 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5324 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5325 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5326 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5327 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5328 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5329 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5330 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5331 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5333 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5334 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5339 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5340 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5341 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5342 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5343 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5344 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5347 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5348 1413 (hence their names):
5351 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5353 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5354 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5355 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5356 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5357 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5358 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5359 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5361 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5362 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5363 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5364 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5366 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5367 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5369 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5370 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5372 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5374 # percent_hack_domains =
5376 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5377 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5378 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5380 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5381 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5382 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5383 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5384 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5385 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5386 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5387 always bounce messages.
5389 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5390 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5392 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5393 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5394 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5395 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5396 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5400 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5401 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5402 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5403 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5404 It starts with the line
5408 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5409 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5410 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5412 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5413 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5414 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5415 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5416 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5417 result of the ACL processing.
5421 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5426 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5427 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5428 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5429 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5430 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5431 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5433 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5434 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5435 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5438 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5439 domains = +local_domains
5440 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5442 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5443 domains = !+local_domains
5444 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5446 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5447 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5448 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5449 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5450 in Internet mail addresses.
5452 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5453 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5454 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5455 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5456 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5457 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5458 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5459 policy of being as safe as possible.
5461 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5462 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5463 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5464 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5465 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5466 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5468 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5469 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5470 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5471 have to modify this rule.
5473 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5474 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5475 common convention of local parts constructed as
5476 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5477 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5478 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5479 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5480 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5481 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5483 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5484 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5485 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5486 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5487 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5488 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5489 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5491 accept local_parts = postmaster
5492 domains = +local_domains
5494 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5495 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5496 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5497 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5498 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5500 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5501 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5502 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5504 require verify = sender
5506 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5507 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5508 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5509 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5510 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5511 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5512 discusses the details of address verification.
5514 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5515 control = submission
5517 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5518 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5519 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5520 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5521 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5522 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5523 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5524 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5525 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5527 accept authenticated = *
5528 control = submission
5530 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5531 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5532 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5533 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5534 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5535 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5537 require message = relay not permitted
5538 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5540 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5541 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5543 require verify = recipient
5545 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5546 fails, the address is rejected.
5548 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5549 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5551 # dnslists = black.list.example
5553 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5554 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5555 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5556 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5558 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5559 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5560 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5563 # require verify = csa
5565 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5566 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5571 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5572 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5576 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5577 of this ACL are commented out:
5580 # message = This message contains a virus \
5583 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5584 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5585 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5586 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5588 # warn spam = nobody
5589 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5590 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5591 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5592 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5594 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5595 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5596 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5597 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5598 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5599 whatever the spam score.
5603 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5606 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5607 .cindex "default" "routers"
5608 .cindex "routers" "default"
5609 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5614 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5615 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5616 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5617 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5618 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5621 # driver = ipliteral
5622 # domains = !+local_domains
5623 # transport = remote_smtp
5625 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5626 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5627 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5628 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5629 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5633 domains = ! +local_domains
5634 transport = remote_smtp
5635 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5638 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5639 domains. This is specified by the line
5641 domains = ! +local_domains
5643 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5644 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5645 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5646 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5647 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5648 passed on to the following routers.
5650 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5651 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5652 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5653 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5654 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5656 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5657 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5658 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5659 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5660 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5661 the address fails and is bounced.
5663 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5664 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5665 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5666 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5667 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5668 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5669 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5676 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5678 file_transport = address_file
5679 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5681 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5682 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5683 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5684 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5685 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5688 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5689 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5690 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5691 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5696 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5697 # local_part_suffix_optional
5698 file = $home/.forward
5703 file_transport = address_file
5704 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5705 reply_transport = address_reply
5707 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5708 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5709 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5710 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5711 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5714 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5715 # local_part_suffix_optional
5717 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5718 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5719 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5720 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5721 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5722 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5723 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5725 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5726 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5727 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5728 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5730 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5731 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5732 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5733 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5734 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5735 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5736 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5738 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5739 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5740 There are two reasons for doing this:
5743 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5744 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5747 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5748 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5749 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5750 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5754 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5755 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5756 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5757 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5759 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5760 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5761 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5763 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5765 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5771 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5772 # local_part_suffix_optional
5773 transport = local_delivery
5775 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5776 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5777 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5778 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5779 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5782 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5783 .cindex "default" "transports"
5784 .cindex "transports" "default"
5785 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5786 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5787 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5791 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5796 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5797 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5801 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5808 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5809 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5810 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5811 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5812 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5813 show how this can be done.
5815 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5816 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5817 similarly-named options above.
5823 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5824 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
5825 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5834 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5835 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5836 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
5841 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5846 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
5847 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
5848 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
5849 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5850 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5851 introduced by the line
5855 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5858 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5860 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
5861 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
5862 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5863 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
5865 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
5866 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
5867 temporary errors into permanent errors.
5870 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
5871 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5875 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5876 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5880 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
5881 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5882 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5884 begin authenticators
5886 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
5887 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
5888 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
5889 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
5890 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
5891 to support most MUA software.
5893 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
5896 # driver = plaintext
5897 # server_set_id = $auth2
5898 # server_prompts = :
5899 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5900 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5902 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
5905 # driver = plaintext
5906 # server_set_id = $auth1
5907 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
5908 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5909 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5912 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
5913 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
5914 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
5915 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
5916 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
5917 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
5918 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
5919 need to add support for TLS as described in &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
5921 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
5922 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
5923 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
5924 expression like one of the examples in &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
5926 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
5927 usercode and password are in different positions. &<<CHAPplaintext>>&
5930 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
5934 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5935 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5937 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
5939 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
5941 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
5942 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
5943 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
5944 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
5945 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
5946 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
5948 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
5949 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
5950 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
5951 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
5952 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
5955 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
5956 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
5957 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
5958 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
5960 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
5962 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
5963 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
5964 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
5965 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
5966 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
5967 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
5970 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
5971 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
5972 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
5973 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
5974 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
5975 match anywhere in the subject string.
5977 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
5978 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
5980 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
5982 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
5985 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
5987 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
5988 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
5992 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5993 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5995 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
5996 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
5997 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
5998 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
5999 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6000 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6003 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6004 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6005 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6006 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6007 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6009 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6010 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6011 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6012 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6013 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6016 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6017 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6018 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6019 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6020 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6021 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6023 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6024 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6025 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6026 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6027 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6029 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6030 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6032 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6033 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6034 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6035 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6036 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6038 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6039 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6041 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6042 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6044 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6045 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6046 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6051 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6052 matches the list item.
6054 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6055 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6057 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6059 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6060 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6061 causes a second lookup to occur.
6063 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6064 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6065 lookup is permitted.
6068 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6069 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6070 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6071 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6074 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6075 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6076 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6078 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6079 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6080 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6081 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6084 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6085 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6086 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6091 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6092 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6093 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6098 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6099 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6100 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6101 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6104 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6105 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6106 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6107 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6108 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6109 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6110 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6111 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6112 be found in several places:
6114 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6115 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6116 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6118 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6119 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6120 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6121 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6123 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6124 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6125 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6126 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6127 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6128 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6129 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6131 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6132 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6133 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6134 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6135 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6136 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6137 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6139 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6140 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6141 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6143 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6144 .cindex "dmbnz lookup type"
6145 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6146 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6147 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6148 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6149 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6150 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6151 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6152 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6154 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6155 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6156 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6157 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6158 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6159 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6160 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6161 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6162 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6164 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6165 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6166 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6167 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6168 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6169 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6170 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6172 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6173 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6174 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6175 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6177 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6178 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6179 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6180 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6181 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6183 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6184 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6185 lookup types support only literal keys.
6187 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6188 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6189 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6191 .cindex "linear search"
6192 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6193 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6194 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6195 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6196 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6197 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6198 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6199 in the file is used.
6201 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6202 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6203 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6204 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6205 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6210 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6211 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6212 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6213 wildcarding of any kind.
6215 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6216 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6217 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6218 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6219 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6220 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6221 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6222 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6223 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6226 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6227 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6228 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6229 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6230 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6231 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6232 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6233 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6236 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6237 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6238 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6239 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6240 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6241 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6242 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6243 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6244 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6246 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6247 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6248 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6249 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6251 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6252 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6255 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6257 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6258 *fish data for anythingfish
6261 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6262 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6264 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6266 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6267 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6268 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6270 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6272 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6273 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6274 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6276 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6279 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6280 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6281 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6282 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6283 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6285 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6286 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6287 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6288 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6289 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6292 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6293 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6294 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6297 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6299 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6302 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6303 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6304 be followed by optional colons.
6306 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6307 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6308 lookup types support only literal keys.
6312 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6313 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6314 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6315 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6316 many of them are given in later sections.
6319 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6320 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6321 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6322 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6323 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6325 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6326 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6327 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6329 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6330 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6331 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6332 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6333 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6334 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6335 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6337 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6338 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6339 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6340 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6342 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6343 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6344 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6345 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6347 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6348 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6349 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6350 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6352 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6353 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6354 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6355 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6356 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6357 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6358 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6359 password value. For example:
6361 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6364 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6365 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6366 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6367 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6370 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6371 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6372 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6373 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6376 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6377 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6379 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6380 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6381 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6382 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6383 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6384 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6385 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6386 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6387 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6389 require condition = \
6390 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6392 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6393 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6394 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6395 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6400 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6401 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6402 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6403 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6404 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6405 options such as a list of local domains.
6407 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6408 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6409 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6410 or may give up altogether.
6414 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6415 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6416 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6417 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6418 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6419 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6420 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6421 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6423 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6424 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6425 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6427 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6428 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6429 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6431 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6432 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6433 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6434 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6435 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6436 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6437 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6438 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6439 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6440 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6442 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6444 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6445 looks up these keys, in this order:
6451 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6452 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6453 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6454 Exim move on to try the next key.
6458 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6459 .cindex "partial matching"
6460 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6461 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6462 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6463 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6464 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6465 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6466 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6467 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6468 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6469 a key in a DBM file is
6471 *.dates.fict.example
6473 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6474 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6475 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6478 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6479 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6480 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6482 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6483 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6484 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6485 partial matching keys
6486 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6487 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6488 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6490 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6491 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6492 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6493 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6494 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6495 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6498 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6499 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6500 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6501 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6502 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6503 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6505 2250.dates.fict.example
6506 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6507 *.dates.fict.example
6510 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6513 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6514 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6515 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6516 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6517 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6518 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6520 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6522 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6523 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6524 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6525 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6527 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6529 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6530 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6532 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6533 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6534 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6537 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6539 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6540 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6542 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6543 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6544 for &"*"& on its own.
6546 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6550 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6551 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6552 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6553 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6554 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6555 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6556 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6558 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6559 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6560 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6561 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6562 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6567 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6568 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6569 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6570 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6571 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6572 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6573 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6575 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6576 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6577 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6578 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6579 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6580 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6582 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6583 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6589 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6590 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6591 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6592 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6593 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6594 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6598 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6599 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6601 [name="$local_part"]
6603 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6604 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6605 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6606 of the following form is provided:
6608 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6610 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6612 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6614 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6615 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6616 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6621 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6622 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6623 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6624 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6625 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6626 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6627 an expansion string could contain:
6629 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6631 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6632 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6633 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6634 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6636 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT, and,
6637 when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6638 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6639 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6640 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6642 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6644 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6645 altered and nothing is added.
6647 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6648 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6649 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6650 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6651 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6653 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6654 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6655 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6656 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6657 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6658 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6660 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6662 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6663 white space is ignored.
6666 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6667 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6668 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6669 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6670 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6672 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6673 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6675 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6676 white space is ignored.
6679 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6680 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6681 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6682 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6683 the pseudo-type MXH:
6685 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6687 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6690 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6691 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6692 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6693 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6694 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6695 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6696 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6697 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6699 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6700 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6702 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6703 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6704 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6706 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6707 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6708 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6709 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6710 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6713 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6714 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6715 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6716 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6717 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6718 result of a successful lookup such as:
6720 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6722 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6723 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6724 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6727 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6728 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6729 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6730 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6731 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6733 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6734 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6735 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6737 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6738 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6739 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6740 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6742 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6743 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6744 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6746 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6747 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6748 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6749 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6750 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6751 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6752 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6753 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6754 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6755 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6757 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6758 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6760 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6761 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6766 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6767 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6768 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6769 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6770 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6771 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6772 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6773 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6774 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6775 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6776 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6777 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6779 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6780 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6781 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6782 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6783 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6785 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6786 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6788 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6789 the way they handle the results of a query:
6792 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6795 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6796 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6798 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6799 from all of them are returned.
6803 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6804 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6805 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6806 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6809 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6810 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6811 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6812 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
6814 data = ${lookup ldap \
6815 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6816 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6818 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
6819 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
6820 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6821 encrypted TLS connection is used.
6824 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
6825 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
6826 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6827 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6828 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6829 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6831 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6832 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6840 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6841 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
6845 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6847 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6851 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6853 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6855 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6857 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6858 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6859 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6863 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
6864 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6865 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6867 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6871 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
6873 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
6875 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
6877 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
6878 authentication below.
6881 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
6882 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
6883 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
6884 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
6885 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
6888 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
6890 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
6891 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
6892 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
6893 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
6894 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
6895 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
6896 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
6897 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
6898 failures, and timeouts.
6900 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
6901 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
6902 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
6903 doubled. For example
6905 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
6907 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
6908 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
6909 the local host) is used.
6911 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
6912 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
6913 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
6914 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
6917 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
6918 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
6919 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
6920 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
6922 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
6924 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
6925 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
6927 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
6929 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
6930 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
6931 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
6932 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
6933 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
6934 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
6935 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
6938 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
6939 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
6940 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
6943 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
6946 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
6950 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
6951 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
6955 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
6956 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
6957 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
6958 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
6959 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
6960 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
6961 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
6962 them. The following names are recognized:
6964 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
6965 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
6966 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
6967 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
6968 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
6969 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
6970 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
6972 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
6973 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
6974 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
6975 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
6977 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
6978 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
6979 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
6980 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
6981 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
6982 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
6983 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
6984 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
6985 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
6987 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
6988 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
6991 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
6992 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
6995 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
6996 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
6999 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7000 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7001 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7002 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7004 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7005 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7006 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7008 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7009 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7010 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7011 quoting has two advantages:
7014 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7015 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7017 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7020 For example, a setting such as
7022 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7024 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7026 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7027 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7028 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7029 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7033 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7034 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7039 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7040 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7041 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7042 as a sequence of values, for example
7044 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7046 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7047 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7048 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7049 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7050 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7053 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7054 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7055 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7057 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7058 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7059 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7060 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7061 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7062 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7063 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7065 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7066 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7067 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7069 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7072 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7075 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7076 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7078 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7079 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7081 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7082 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7083 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7084 results of LDAP lookups.
7089 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7090 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7091 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7092 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7093 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7094 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7095 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7096 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7098 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7100 might return the string
7102 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7103 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7105 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7107 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7113 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7114 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7115 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7119 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7120 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7121 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7122 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7123 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7124 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7125 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7126 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7127 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7128 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7129 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7130 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7133 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7136 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7137 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7139 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7144 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7146 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7147 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7148 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7152 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7153 with a newline between the data for each row.
7156 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7157 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7158 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7159 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7160 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7161 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7162 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7163 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7164 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7165 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7166 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7167 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7169 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7170 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7171 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7172 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7173 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7174 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7176 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7178 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7179 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7180 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7182 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7183 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7185 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7186 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7187 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7188 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7189 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7190 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7192 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7193 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7194 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7195 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7196 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7197 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7198 characters are not special.
7200 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7201 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7202 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7203 done by starting the query with
7205 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7207 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7209 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7210 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7211 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7214 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7216 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7217 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7218 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7220 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7221 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7222 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7225 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7229 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7231 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7233 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7234 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7235 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7237 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7241 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7242 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7243 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7244 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7245 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7247 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7248 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7250 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7251 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7253 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7256 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7257 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7259 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7260 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7261 is zero because no rows are affected.
7264 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7265 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7266 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7267 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7268 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7271 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7273 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7274 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7275 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7277 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7278 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7281 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7282 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7283 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7284 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7285 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7286 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7287 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7288 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7289 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7291 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7292 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7294 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7296 domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7297 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7299 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7300 quote, which it doubles.
7302 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7303 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7304 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7305 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7306 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7307 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7313 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7314 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7316 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7317 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7318 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7319 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7320 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7321 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7322 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7323 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7324 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7326 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7327 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7328 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7329 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7333 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7334 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7335 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7336 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7337 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7338 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7339 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7340 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7343 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7344 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7345 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7347 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7348 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7349 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7350 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7351 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7353 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7354 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7356 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7357 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7358 senders based on the receiving domain.
7363 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7364 .cindex "list" "negation"
7365 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7366 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7367 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7368 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7369 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7370 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7372 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7373 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7374 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7375 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7376 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7378 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7380 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7381 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7382 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7384 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7386 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7387 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7388 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7390 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7391 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7396 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7397 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7398 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7399 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7400 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7401 file names are not allowed,
7402 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7403 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7407 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7408 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7410 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7411 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7412 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7414 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7418 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7419 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7420 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7421 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7423 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7424 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7426 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7428 and the file contains the lines
7433 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7434 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7438 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7439 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7440 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7441 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7442 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7443 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7444 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7445 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7447 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7448 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7449 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7450 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7455 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7456 .cindex "named lists"
7457 .cindex "list" "named"
7458 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7459 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7460 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7461 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7462 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7463 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7464 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7466 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7468 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7469 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7470 configured with the line
7472 domains = +local_domains
7474 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7475 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7479 domains = ! +local_domains
7480 transport = remote_smtp
7483 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7484 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7485 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7486 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7488 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7489 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7491 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7493 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7494 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7495 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7497 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7498 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7499 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7501 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7502 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7504 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7505 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7506 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7508 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7510 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7511 referenced lists if you can.
7513 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7514 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7515 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7517 domains = +local_domains
7519 on several of your routers
7520 or in several ACL statements,
7521 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7522 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7523 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7524 the same each time they are referenced.
7526 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7527 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7528 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7529 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7533 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7534 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7535 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7536 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7537 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7540 ALIST = host1 : host2
7541 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7543 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7545 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7547 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7550 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7551 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7553 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7555 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7559 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7560 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7561 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7562 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7563 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7564 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7565 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7566 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7567 message. For example:
7569 domainlist special_domains = \
7570 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7572 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7573 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7574 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7575 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7576 same list each time.
7578 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7579 cache the result anyway. For example:
7581 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7583 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7584 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7588 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7589 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7590 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7591 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7592 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7595 .cindex "primary host name"
7596 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7597 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7598 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7599 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7600 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7601 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7602 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7603 differ only in their names.
7605 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7606 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7607 .cindex "domain literal"
7608 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7609 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7610 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7611 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7612 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7613 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7616 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7617 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7618 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7619 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7620 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7621 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7622 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7623 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7624 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7625 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7626 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7628 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7629 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7630 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7631 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7632 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7634 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7635 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7636 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7637 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7638 on a router). For example:
7640 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7642 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7643 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7645 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7646 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7647 contain negative items.
7649 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7650 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7651 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7653 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7654 an.other.domain : ...
7656 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7657 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7659 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7660 an.other.domain ? ...
7663 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7664 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7665 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7666 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7667 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7668 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7669 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7670 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7671 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7675 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7676 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7677 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7678 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7679 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7680 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7681 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7682 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7683 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7685 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7686 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7687 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7688 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7689 expression by expansion, of course).
7691 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7692 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7693 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7694 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7695 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7696 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7698 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7700 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7701 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7702 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7703 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7704 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7705 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7706 other statements in the same ACL.
7709 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7710 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7712 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7714 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7715 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7718 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7719 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7720 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7721 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7722 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7723 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7726 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7727 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7728 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7729 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7731 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7732 where domain = '$domain';
7734 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7735 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7736 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7737 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7738 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7740 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7741 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7742 between the pattern and the domain.
7745 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7747 domainlist funny_domains = \
7750 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7751 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7752 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7753 nis;domains.byname : \
7754 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7756 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7757 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7758 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7759 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7760 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7765 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7766 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7767 .cindex "list" "host list"
7768 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7769 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7770 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7771 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7772 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7773 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7774 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7777 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7778 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7779 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7780 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7781 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7782 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7785 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7786 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7787 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7791 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7792 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7793 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7794 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7795 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7796 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7797 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7800 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7801 inspecting its IP address:
7804 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7805 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7806 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7807 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
7808 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7809 with the IP address of the subject host.
7811 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7812 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7813 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
7814 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
7815 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7818 .cindex "@ in a host list"
7819 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7820 domain name, as just described.
7823 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7824 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
7825 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7826 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7827 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7828 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7829 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7830 that can never match a client host.
7833 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
7834 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7835 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7836 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7838 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7842 .cindex "CIDR notation"
7843 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7844 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7845 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
7846 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
7847 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
7848 significant end of the address.
7850 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7851 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7852 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7853 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7857 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
7858 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
7861 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7863 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7864 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7866 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7867 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
7870 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
7872 could make use of a file containing
7877 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
7878 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
7879 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
7881 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
7884 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
7890 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
7891 "SECThoslispatsikey"
7892 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
7893 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
7894 address, the pattern takes this form:
7896 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7900 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
7902 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
7903 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
7904 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
7905 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
7906 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
7907 returned by the lookup is not used.
7909 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
7910 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
7911 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
7912 patterns of this form:
7914 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7918 net24-dbm;/networks.db
7920 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
7921 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
7922 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
7923 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
7924 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
7926 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
7927 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
7928 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
7929 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
7930 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
7931 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
7932 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
7933 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
7934 addresses are always used.
7936 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
7937 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
7938 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
7941 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
7942 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
7943 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
7944 case the IP address is used on its own.
7948 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
7949 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
7950 .cindex "unknown host name"
7951 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
7952 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
7953 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
7954 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
7955 address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
7958 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
7959 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
7960 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
7961 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
7962 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
7963 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
7964 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
7966 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
7967 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
7969 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
7970 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
7971 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
7972 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
7973 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
7974 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
7975 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
7976 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
7977 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
7979 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
7980 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7982 .cindex "host" "alias for"
7983 .cindex "alias for host"
7984 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
7985 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
7988 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7989 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
7990 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
7991 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
7992 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
7995 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
7996 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
7997 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
7998 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
7999 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8000 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8001 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8006 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8007 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8008 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8009 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8010 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8012 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8014 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8015 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8016 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8023 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8024 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8025 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8026 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8027 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8028 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8030 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8031 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8033 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8034 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8035 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
8036 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
8037 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8038 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8041 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8042 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8044 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8046 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8047 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8050 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8051 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8054 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8057 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8058 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8059 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8062 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8063 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8067 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8069 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8070 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8071 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8072 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8073 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8074 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8075 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8076 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8077 host lists such as whitelists.
8081 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8082 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8083 .cindex "unknown host name"
8084 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8085 If a pattern is of the form
8087 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8091 dbm;/host/accept/list
8093 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8094 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8097 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8098 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8099 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8100 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8101 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8102 lookup, both using the same file.
8106 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8107 If a pattern is of the form
8109 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8111 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8112 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8113 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8115 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8116 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8118 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8119 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8120 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8123 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8124 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8125 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8127 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8128 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8129 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8130 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8131 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8132 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8136 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8138 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8139 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8140 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8143 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8145 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8146 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8147 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8148 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8149 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8150 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8152 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8153 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8155 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8156 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8158 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8159 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8165 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8166 .cindex "list" "address list"
8167 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8168 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8169 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8170 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8171 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8172 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8173 using this option setting:
8177 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8178 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8179 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8180 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8182 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8185 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8187 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8188 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8189 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8190 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8191 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8192 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8193 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8195 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8196 *@+hostile_domains:\
8197 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8198 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8200 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8201 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8202 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8203 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8204 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8206 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8207 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8208 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8209 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8210 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8212 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8215 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8216 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8220 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8221 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8222 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8223 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8224 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8225 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8226 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8228 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8229 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8231 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8232 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8235 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8236 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8237 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8240 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8241 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8242 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8244 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8245 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8246 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8247 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8249 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8250 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8252 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8253 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8254 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8255 default. For example, with this lookup:
8257 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8259 the file could contains lines like this:
8261 user1@domain1.example
8264 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8267 nimrod@jaeger.example
8271 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8272 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8274 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8276 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8277 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8279 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8280 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8281 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8285 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8286 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8291 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8292 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8293 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8294 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8295 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8296 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8297 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8298 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8299 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8301 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8302 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8303 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8304 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8305 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8308 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8310 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8312 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8314 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8316 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8317 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8318 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8319 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8320 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8321 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8323 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8326 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8329 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8330 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8331 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8332 might have entries like
8334 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8335 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8338 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8339 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8340 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8341 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8343 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8344 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8345 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8348 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8349 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8350 can only return a single list of local parts.
8353 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8354 in these two examples:
8357 senders = *@+my_list
8359 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8360 example it is a named domain list.
8365 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8366 .cindex "case of local parts"
8367 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8368 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8369 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8370 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8371 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8372 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8373 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8374 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8377 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8378 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8379 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8380 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8381 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8382 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8383 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8386 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8387 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8388 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8389 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8390 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8391 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8392 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8393 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8397 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8398 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8399 .cindex "local part" "list"
8400 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8401 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8402 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8403 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8404 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8405 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8406 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8407 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8409 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8410 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8411 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8412 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8413 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8414 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8415 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8417 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8422 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8423 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8425 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8426 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8427 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8428 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8430 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8431 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8432 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8433 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8434 escape character, as described in the following section.
8438 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8439 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8440 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8441 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8442 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8443 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8444 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8445 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8447 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8448 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8449 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8450 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8452 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8454 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8455 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8460 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8461 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8462 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8463 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8464 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8465 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8466 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8469 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8470 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8471 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8474 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8475 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8476 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8478 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8479 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8480 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8481 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8482 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8483 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8484 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8487 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8488 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8489 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8492 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8493 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8494 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8495 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8497 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8499 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8500 Exim message identifier. For example:
8502 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8504 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8505 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8508 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8509 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8510 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8511 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8512 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8513 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8514 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8515 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8516 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8517 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8518 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8519 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8525 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8526 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8527 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8528 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8529 white space is significant.
8532 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8533 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8534 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8539 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8540 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8541 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8542 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8543 given, the expansion fails.
8545 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8546 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8547 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8548 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8552 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8553 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8554 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8555 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8556 string easier to understand.
8558 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8559 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8560 expansion item below.
8562 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8563 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8565 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8566 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8570 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8571 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8572 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8574 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8575 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8576 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8577 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8578 must have the following type:
8580 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8582 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8583 function should return one of the following values:
8585 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8586 into the expanded string that is being built.
8588 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8589 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8591 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8592 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8594 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8596 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8597 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8598 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8600 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8601 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8602 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8603 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8604 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8605 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8606 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8609 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8612 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8613 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8614 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8615 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8616 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8617 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8618 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8619 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8620 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8622 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8623 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8624 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8627 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8628 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8630 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8631 appear, for example:
8633 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8635 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8636 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8639 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8640 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8641 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8642 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8643 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8644 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8645 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8646 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8647 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8648 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8649 <&'string3'&> as before.
8651 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8652 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8653 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8654 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8655 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8656 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8657 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8658 provided. For example:
8660 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8664 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8666 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8667 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8670 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8671 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8672 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8674 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8675 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8676 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8677 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8678 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8679 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8680 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8682 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8684 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8685 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8688 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8689 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8690 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8691 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8692 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8693 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8695 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8696 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8697 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8698 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8700 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8702 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8703 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8704 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8705 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8706 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8708 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8710 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8711 letters appear. For example:
8713 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8714 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8715 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8718 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8719 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8720 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8721 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8722 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8723 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8724 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8725 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8726 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8727 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8728 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8729 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8730 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8731 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8735 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8736 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8737 lines) may be present.
8739 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8740 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8743 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8744 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8745 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8748 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8749 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8750 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8751 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8752 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8753 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8754 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8755 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8758 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8759 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8760 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8761 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8762 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8763 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8766 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8767 command of the following form:
8769 headers charset "UTF-8"
8771 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8772 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8773 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8774 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8775 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8778 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8779 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8780 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8781 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8783 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8784 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8785 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8786 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8787 router or transport are not accessible.
8789 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8790 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8791 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8792 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8793 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8794 by earlier ACLs are visible.
8796 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8797 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8798 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8799 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8800 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8801 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
8802 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8804 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8805 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
8806 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
8807 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
8808 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
8809 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
8810 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
8811 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
8814 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
8815 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
8817 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8818 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8819 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
8820 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8821 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8822 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
8823 present. For example:
8825 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8827 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8830 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8832 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8833 an Exim configuration:
8835 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8837 In a router or a transport you could then have:
8840 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
8841 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8842 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
8844 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8845 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
8846 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
8847 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
8848 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
8849 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
8852 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8853 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
8854 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
8855 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
8856 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
8857 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
8859 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8861 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
8862 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
8863 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
8864 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
8865 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
8867 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
8868 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
8869 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
8871 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
8875 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
8878 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8879 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
8880 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
8881 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
8882 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
8883 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
8884 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
8887 ${length_<n>:<string>}
8889 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
8890 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
8891 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
8894 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
8895 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8896 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
8897 described in the next item.
8899 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
8900 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8901 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
8902 .cindex "file" "lookups"
8903 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
8904 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
8905 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
8906 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
8907 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
8909 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
8910 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
8911 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
8912 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
8913 out by the system administrator.
8916 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
8917 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
8918 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
8919 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
8920 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
8921 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
8922 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
8923 original lookup fails.
8925 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
8926 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
8927 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
8928 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
8929 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
8930 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
8931 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
8932 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
8934 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
8935 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
8936 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
8937 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
8939 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
8940 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
8941 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
8942 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
8944 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
8946 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
8948 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
8949 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
8951 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
8956 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8957 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
8959 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8960 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8961 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
8962 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
8963 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
8964 setting is not included in the output. For example:
8966 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
8968 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
8969 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
8970 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8972 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8973 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
8974 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
8975 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
8976 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
8977 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
8978 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8980 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8982 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
8983 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
8984 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
8985 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
8988 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
8990 returns the string &"6/33"&.
8994 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
8995 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
8996 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
8997 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
8998 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
8999 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9000 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9001 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9003 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9004 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9005 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9006 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9007 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9010 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9011 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9012 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9014 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9015 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9018 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9019 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9020 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9021 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9022 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9023 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9024 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9025 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9027 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9028 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9029 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9030 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9031 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9032 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9033 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9034 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9035 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9036 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9038 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9039 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9040 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9041 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9043 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9044 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9045 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9046 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9047 is the expansion of the third argument.
9049 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9050 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9051 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9053 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9054 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9055 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9056 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9057 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9058 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9059 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9060 newlines are left in the string.
9061 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9062 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9063 the string expansion fails.
9065 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9066 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9070 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9071 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9072 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9073 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9074 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9075 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9076 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9079 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9080 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9082 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9083 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9084 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9085 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9086 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9089 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9091 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9092 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9093 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9094 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9095 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9096 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9098 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9100 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9101 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9102 turns them into spaces:
9104 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9106 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9107 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9108 addition, the following errors can occur:
9111 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9113 Failure to connect the socket;
9115 Failure to write the request string;
9117 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9120 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9121 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9122 errors occurs. For example:
9124 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9127 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9128 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9129 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9130 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9131 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9133 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9134 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9137 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9138 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9139 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9142 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9143 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9144 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9145 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9146 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9147 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9148 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9149 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9150 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9152 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9154 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9157 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9159 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9160 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9163 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9164 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9165 expansion item above.
9167 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9168 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9169 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9170 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9171 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9172 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9173 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9174 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9176 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9177 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9178 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9180 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9181 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9182 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9183 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9184 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9187 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9188 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9189 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9190 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9193 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9194 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9196 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9197 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9201 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9202 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9205 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9206 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9207 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9208 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9210 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9211 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9214 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9215 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9216 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9217 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9218 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9219 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9220 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9221 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9223 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9225 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9226 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9227 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9229 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9231 yields &"defabc"&, and
9233 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9235 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9236 the regular expression from string expansion.
9240 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9241 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9242 .cindex "substring extraction"
9243 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9244 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9245 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9246 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9247 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9249 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9251 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9252 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9255 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9256 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9257 length required. For example
9259 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9261 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9262 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9263 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9264 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9266 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9267 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9268 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9270 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9272 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9273 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9274 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9276 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9278 yields an empty string, but
9280 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9284 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9285 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9286 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9287 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9290 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9292 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9296 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9297 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9298 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9299 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9300 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9301 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9302 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9303 replacement list. For example
9305 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9307 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9308 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9309 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9315 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9316 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9317 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9318 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9319 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9320 following operations can be performed:
9323 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9324 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9325 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9326 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9327 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9328 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9331 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9332 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9333 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9334 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9335 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9336 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9337 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9338 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9339 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9341 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9342 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9343 character. For example:
9345 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9347 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9348 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9349 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9353 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9354 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9355 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9356 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9357 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9358 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9359 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9360 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9361 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9363 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9364 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9365 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9366 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9367 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9368 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9371 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9372 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9373 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9374 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9375 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9378 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9379 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9380 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9381 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9382 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9383 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9384 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9387 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9388 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9389 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9390 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9391 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9392 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9393 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9394 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9395 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9396 C programming language):
9398 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9399 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9400 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9401 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9404 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9406 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9407 space is permitted before or after operators.
9409 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9410 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9411 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9412 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9413 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9415 A number may be followed by &"K"& or &"M"& to multiply it by 1024 or 1024*1024,
9416 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9417 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"& or &"M"&). For example:
9420 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9421 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9422 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9423 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9424 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
9425 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9426 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9427 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9428 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9429 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
9430 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9433 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9435 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9438 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9441 {$recipients_count} \
9442 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9446 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9447 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9450 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9451 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9452 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9455 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9457 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9458 and then re-expands what it has found.
9461 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9463 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9464 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9465 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9466 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9467 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9468 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9469 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9470 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9471 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9473 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9474 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9475 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9476 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9477 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9478 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9479 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9482 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9483 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9484 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9485 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9486 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9487 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9489 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9491 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9492 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9496 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9497 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9498 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9499 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9500 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9501 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9504 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9505 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9506 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9507 .cindex "lower casing"
9508 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9509 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9510 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9515 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9516 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9517 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9518 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9519 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9520 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9522 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9524 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9525 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9526 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9529 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9530 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9531 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9532 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9533 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9537 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9538 .cindex "masked IP address"
9539 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9540 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9541 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9542 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9543 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9544 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9545 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9546 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9547 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9549 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9551 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9552 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9553 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9554 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9556 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9560 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9562 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9565 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9567 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9568 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9569 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9570 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9573 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9574 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9575 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9576 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9577 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9578 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9580 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9582 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9585 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9586 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9587 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9588 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9589 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9590 is an empty string or
9591 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9592 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9593 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9594 respectively For example,
9602 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9603 variable or a message header.
9605 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9606 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9607 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9608 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9609 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9610 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9611 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9614 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9615 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9616 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9617 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9618 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9620 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9626 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9627 yields an unchanged string.
9630 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
9631 .cindex "random number"
9632 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
9633 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
9634 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
9635 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
9636 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
9637 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
9641 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
9642 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
9643 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
9644 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
9645 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
9646 for DNS. For example,
9648 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4} and ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.3}
9652 4.2.0.192 and 3.0.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
9656 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9657 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9658 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9659 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9660 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9661 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9662 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9663 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9664 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9667 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9669 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9670 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9674 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9675 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9676 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9677 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9678 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9679 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9680 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9681 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9683 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9684 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9685 to use this operator as well.
9689 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9690 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9691 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9692 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9693 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9694 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9695 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9698 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9699 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9700 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9701 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9702 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9703 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9706 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9707 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9708 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9709 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9710 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9711 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9712 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9713 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9714 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9715 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
9716 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9717 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9718 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9720 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9721 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9722 systems for files larger than 2GB.
9724 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9725 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9726 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9727 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9728 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9732 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9733 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
9734 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9735 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9736 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9737 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9740 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9741 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9742 .cindex "substring extraction"
9743 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9744 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9745 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9746 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9748 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9750 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9751 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9753 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9754 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9755 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9756 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9759 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9760 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9761 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9762 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9763 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9764 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9767 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9768 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9769 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9770 .cindex "upper casing"
9771 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9772 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9773 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
9781 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
9782 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
9783 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
9784 while expanding strings:
9787 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
9788 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
9789 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
9790 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9793 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9794 .cindex "numeric comparison"
9795 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
9796 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
9802 &`>= `& greater or equal
9804 &`<= `& less or equal
9808 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9810 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9811 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9812 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
9813 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
9814 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
9817 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9818 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9819 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
9820 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
9821 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
9822 (case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
9823 false if zero. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
9824 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
9826 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
9827 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
9830 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
9833 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9834 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9835 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
9836 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
9837 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
9838 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
9839 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
9840 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
9842 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
9844 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9845 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
9846 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
9847 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
9848 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
9849 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
9850 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
9851 included in the binary.
9853 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
9854 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
9855 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
9856 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
9857 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
9858 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
9859 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
9860 string in LDAP form is:
9862 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
9864 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
9865 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
9867 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
9869 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
9874 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
9875 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9876 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9877 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
9878 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
9879 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
9883 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9884 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9885 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9886 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
9887 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
9888 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
9891 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
9892 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
9893 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
9894 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
9895 whatever its length.
9898 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
9899 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
9900 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
9901 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
9903 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
9904 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
9905 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
9906 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
9907 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
9908 support &[crypt16()]&.
9910 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
9911 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
9912 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
9913 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
9914 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
9916 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
9917 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
9918 Exim is seen as very low priority.
9920 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
9921 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
9922 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
9923 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
9924 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
9926 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
9927 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
9928 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
9929 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
9930 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
9931 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
9933 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
9935 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
9936 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
9938 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
9939 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9940 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
9941 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
9942 exists in the message. For example,
9944 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
9946 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
9947 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
9949 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9950 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9951 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9952 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9953 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
9954 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
9955 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
9956 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
9957 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
9959 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
9960 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
9961 .cindex "file" "existence test"
9962 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
9963 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
9964 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
9965 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
9966 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
9968 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
9969 .cindex "delivery" "first"
9970 .cindex "first delivery"
9971 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
9972 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
9973 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
9974 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
9977 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
9978 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
9979 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
9980 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
9981 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
9983 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
9984 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
9985 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
9986 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
9987 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
9989 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
9990 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
9991 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
9993 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
9994 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
9995 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
9997 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
9998 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
9999 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10000 list separator is changed to a comma:
10002 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10004 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10005 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10008 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10009 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10010 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10011 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10012 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10013 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10014 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10015 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10016 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10019 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10020 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10021 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10022 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10023 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10024 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10025 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10026 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10027 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10030 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10031 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10032 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10033 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10034 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10035 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10036 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10037 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10038 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10039 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10040 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10042 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10043 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10044 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10045 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10046 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10048 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10049 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10050 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10051 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10053 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10055 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10057 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10058 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10059 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10060 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10061 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10062 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10063 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10064 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10065 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10066 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10067 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10068 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10069 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10073 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10074 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10075 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10076 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10077 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10078 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10079 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10080 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10081 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10084 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10085 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10086 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10087 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10088 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10089 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10090 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10091 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10092 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10096 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10097 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10098 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10099 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10100 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10101 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10102 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10103 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10104 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10105 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10106 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10109 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10111 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10112 backslashes is also required.
10114 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10115 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10116 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10117 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10118 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10119 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10121 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10122 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10123 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10124 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10125 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10126 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10127 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10128 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10130 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10131 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10132 See &*match_local_part*&.
10134 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10135 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10136 See &*match_local_part*&.
10138 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10139 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10140 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10141 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10142 address or an empty string. The second (after expansion) is a restricted host
10143 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10145 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10147 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10150 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10152 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10154 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10155 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10156 in a single test such as
10157 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10158 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10159 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10160 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10162 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10164 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10166 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10168 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10169 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10170 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10171 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10172 masks. For example:
10174 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10176 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10177 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10178 address mask, for example:
10180 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10182 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10183 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10185 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10189 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10191 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10192 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10193 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10194 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10195 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10196 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10197 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10198 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10201 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10203 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10204 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10205 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10206 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10208 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10210 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10211 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10212 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10213 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10216 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10217 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10218 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10219 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10221 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10222 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10223 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10224 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10225 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10226 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10227 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10228 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10229 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10230 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10231 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10235 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10236 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10238 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10239 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10240 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10241 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10242 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10243 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10244 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10246 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10247 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10248 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10249 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10250 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10252 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10254 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10256 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10258 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10259 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10260 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10261 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10262 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10263 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10264 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10265 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10268 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10269 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10271 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10272 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10273 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10274 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10275 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10276 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10278 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10279 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10280 building Exim. For example:
10282 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10284 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10285 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10286 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10287 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10289 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10290 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10291 configuration, you might have this:
10293 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10295 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10297 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10299 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10300 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10301 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10302 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10303 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10304 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10307 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10309 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10310 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10311 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10312 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10313 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10316 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10317 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10318 this library, you need to set
10320 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10322 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10323 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10325 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10327 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10328 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10329 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10331 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10332 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10333 the authentication is successful. For example:
10335 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10339 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10340 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10341 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10343 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10344 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10345 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10346 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10347 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10348 by a process that is not running as root.
10350 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10351 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10352 building Exim. For example:
10354 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10356 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10357 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10358 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10360 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10361 two are mandatory. For example:
10363 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10365 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10366 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10367 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10372 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10373 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10374 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10375 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10376 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10377 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10378 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10382 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10383 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10384 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10385 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10386 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10389 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10391 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10392 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10393 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10395 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10396 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10397 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10398 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10399 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10400 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10401 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10402 parsed but not evaluated.
10404 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10409 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10410 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10411 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10412 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10413 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10416 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10417 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10418 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10419 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10420 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10421 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10422 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10423 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10424 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10425 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10426 matching condition.
10428 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10429 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10430 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10431 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10432 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10433 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10434 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10435 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10436 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10437 during subsequent delivery.
10439 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10440 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10441 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10442 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10443 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10444 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10445 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10446 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10449 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10450 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10451 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10452 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10453 be preserved by coding like this:
10455 warn !verify = sender
10456 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10458 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10459 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10462 .vitem &$address_data$&
10463 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10464 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10465 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10466 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10467 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10468 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10471 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10472 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10473 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10474 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10475 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10476 from the child's routing.
10478 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10479 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10480 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10483 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10484 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10485 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10487 .vitem &$address_file$&
10488 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10489 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10490 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10491 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10492 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10494 /home/r2d2/savemail
10496 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10497 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10498 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10499 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10500 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10501 to the relevant file.
10503 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10504 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10505 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10506 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10508 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10509 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10510 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10511 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10513 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10514 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10515 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10516 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10517 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10518 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10519 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10520 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10521 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10522 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10523 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10524 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10525 command line option.
10530 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10531 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10532 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10533 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10534 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10535 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10536 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10537 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10538 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10539 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10540 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10542 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10543 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10544 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10545 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10546 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10549 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10550 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10551 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10552 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10553 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10554 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10555 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10556 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10557 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10558 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10559 an undefined mechanism.
10561 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10562 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10563 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10564 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10565 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10566 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10568 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10569 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10570 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10571 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10572 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10573 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10574 number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
10576 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10577 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10578 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10579 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10580 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10582 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10583 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10584 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10585 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10586 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10588 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10589 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10590 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10591 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10592 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10593 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10594 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10596 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10597 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10598 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10599 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10600 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10601 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10602 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10604 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10605 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10606 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10608 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10609 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10610 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10611 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10612 compilations of the same version of the program.
10614 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10615 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10616 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10617 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10618 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10620 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10621 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10622 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10623 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10624 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10626 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10627 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10628 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10630 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10631 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10632 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10633 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10634 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10635 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10636 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10637 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10638 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10641 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10642 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10643 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10644 case for &$domain$&.
10646 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10647 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10648 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10649 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10651 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10652 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10653 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10654 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10655 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10656 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10658 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10659 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10660 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10662 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10665 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10666 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10667 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10668 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10669 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10670 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10671 the &(smtp)& transport.
10674 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10675 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10676 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10677 rewrite domains by file lookup.
10680 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10681 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10682 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10683 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10684 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10685 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10688 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10689 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10690 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10691 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10695 .vitem &$domain_data$&
10696 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10697 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10698 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10699 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10700 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10701 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10704 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10705 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10706 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10709 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
10710 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10711 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10713 .vitem &$exim_path$&
10714 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10715 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10717 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
10718 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10719 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10721 .vitem &$found_extension$&
10722 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10723 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10724 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10725 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10727 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10728 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10729 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10730 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10731 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10735 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10736 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
10737 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
10738 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
10739 by a setting on the transport itself.
10741 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
10742 of the environment variable HOME.
10746 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
10747 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
10748 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
10749 to local and remote transports.
10751 .cindex "transport" "filter"
10752 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
10753 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
10754 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
10755 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
10756 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
10757 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
10760 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
10761 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
10762 client is connected.
10765 .vitem &$host_address$&
10766 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
10767 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
10768 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
10769 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
10771 .vitem &$host_data$&
10772 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
10773 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
10774 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
10775 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
10777 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
10778 message = $host_data
10780 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
10781 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
10782 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
10783 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
10784 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
10785 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
10786 variables is set to &"1"&.
10789 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
10790 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
10793 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
10794 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
10795 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
10798 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
10799 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
10800 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
10801 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
10802 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
10803 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
10804 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
10805 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
10806 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
10807 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
10809 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
10810 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
10811 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
10815 .vindex "&$inode$&"
10816 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
10817 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
10818 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
10819 a unique name for the file.
10821 .vitem &$interface_address$&
10822 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
10823 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
10825 .vitem &$interface_port$&
10826 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
10827 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
10831 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
10832 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
10833 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
10837 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
10838 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
10839 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
10842 .vitem &$load_average$&
10843 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
10844 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
10845 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
10846 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
10848 .vitem &$local_part$&
10849 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
10850 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
10851 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
10852 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
10853 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
10855 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10856 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
10857 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
10858 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
10861 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10862 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10863 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
10864 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
10865 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
10866 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
10868 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
10869 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
10870 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
10873 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
10874 local part of the recipient address.
10876 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10877 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
10878 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
10880 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
10883 "abc:xyz"@test.example
10884 abc\:xyz@test.example
10886 the value of &$local_part$& is
10890 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
10891 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
10894 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
10896 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
10897 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
10898 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
10900 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
10901 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
10902 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
10903 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
10904 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
10905 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
10906 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
10908 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
10909 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
10910 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
10911 variable expands to nothing.
10913 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
10914 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10915 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10916 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10917 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10919 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
10920 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10921 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10922 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10923 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10925 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
10926 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
10927 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
10928 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
10930 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
10931 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
10932 See &$local_user_uid$&.
10934 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
10935 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
10936 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
10937 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
10938 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
10939 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
10940 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
10941 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
10943 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
10944 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
10945 This contains the expanded value of the
10946 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
10949 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
10950 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
10951 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
10952 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
10953 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
10954 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
10956 .vitem &$log_space$&
10957 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
10958 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
10959 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
10960 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
10961 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
10962 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
10965 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
10966 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
10967 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
10968 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
10969 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
10970 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
10971 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
10974 .vitem &$malware_name$&
10975 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
10976 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10977 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
10978 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
10980 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
10981 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
10982 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
10983 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
10984 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
10985 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
10988 .vitem &$message_age$&
10989 .cindex "message" "age of"
10990 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
10991 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
10992 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
10995 .vitem &$message_body$&
10996 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10997 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10998 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10999 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11000 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11001 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11002 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11003 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11004 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11006 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11007 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11008 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11009 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11010 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11012 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11013 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11014 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11015 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11016 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11017 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11020 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11021 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11022 .cindex "message body" "size"
11023 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11024 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11025 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11026 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11027 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11029 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11030 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11031 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11032 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11033 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11034 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11035 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11036 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11038 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11039 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11040 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11041 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11042 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11043 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11045 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11046 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11047 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11048 contents of header lines is done.
11050 .vitem &$message_id$&
11051 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11053 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11054 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11055 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11056 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11057 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11058 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11059 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11060 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11061 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11062 from the body is not counted. Here is an example of the use of this variable in
11065 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11067 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11069 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11070 message has not yet been received.
11072 .vitem &$message_size$&
11073 .cindex "size" "of message"
11074 .cindex "message" "size"
11075 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11076 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11077 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11078 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11079 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11080 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11081 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11082 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11083 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11085 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11086 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11087 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11088 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11090 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11091 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11092 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11093 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11095 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11096 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11097 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11099 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11100 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11101 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11102 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11103 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11104 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11105 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11106 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11107 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11108 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11110 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11111 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11112 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11114 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11115 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11116 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11117 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11118 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11119 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11120 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11121 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11122 the original address.
11124 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11125 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11126 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11127 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11128 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11130 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11131 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11132 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11134 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11135 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11136 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11137 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11138 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11139 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11140 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11141 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11142 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11144 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11145 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11146 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11147 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11148 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11149 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11150 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11151 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11154 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11155 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11156 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11157 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11159 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11160 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11161 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11162 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11165 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11167 This variable contains the current process id.
11169 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11170 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11171 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11172 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11173 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11174 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11175 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11176 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11177 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11178 variable"& error if encountered.
11180 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11181 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11182 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11183 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11184 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11185 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11186 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11189 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11190 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11191 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11192 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11194 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11195 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11196 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11197 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11199 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11200 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11201 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11202 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11204 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11205 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11206 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11208 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11209 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11210 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11211 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11213 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11214 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11215 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11216 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11217 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11219 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11220 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11221 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11222 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11223 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11224 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11226 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11227 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11228 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11229 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11230 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11232 .vitem &$received_count$&
11233 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11234 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11235 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11236 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11239 .vitem &$received_for$&
11240 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11241 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11242 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11243 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11244 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11246 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11247 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11248 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11249 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11250 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11251 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11252 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11255 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11256 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11257 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11258 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11259 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11262 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11263 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11264 &(smtp)& transport).
11266 .vitem &$received_port$&
11267 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11268 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11270 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11271 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11272 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11273 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11274 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11275 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11276 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11277 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11278 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11280 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11281 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11282 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11283 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11284 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11285 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11287 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11288 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11289 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11291 .vitem &$received_time$&
11292 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11293 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11294 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11296 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11297 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11298 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11299 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11300 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11302 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11303 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11305 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11306 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11307 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11308 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11310 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11311 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11312 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11313 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11316 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11317 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11320 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11323 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11324 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11328 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11331 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11334 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11335 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11337 .vitem &$recipients$&
11338 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11339 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11340 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11341 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11342 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11346 In a system filter file.
11348 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11349 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11350 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11351 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11353 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11357 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11358 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11359 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11360 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11361 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11362 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11365 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11366 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11367 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11368 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11371 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11372 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11373 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11374 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11375 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11376 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11377 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11379 .vitem &$return_path$&
11380 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11381 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11382 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11383 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11384 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11385 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11386 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11387 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11388 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11389 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11392 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11393 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11394 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11397 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11398 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11399 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11400 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11401 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11402 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11403 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11406 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11407 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11408 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11409 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11410 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11411 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11412 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11413 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11415 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11416 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11417 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11418 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11419 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11420 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11422 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11423 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11424 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11425 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11426 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11427 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11428 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11429 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11431 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11432 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11433 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11435 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11436 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11437 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11439 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11440 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11441 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11442 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11443 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11446 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11447 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11449 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11450 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11451 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11452 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11454 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11455 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11456 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11457 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11458 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11459 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11460 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11461 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11462 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11463 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11464 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11465 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11466 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11468 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11469 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11470 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11471 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11472 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11473 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11475 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11476 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11477 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11478 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11480 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11481 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11482 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11483 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11484 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11485 &$authenticated_id$&.
11487 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11488 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11489 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11490 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11491 other means, this variable is empty.
11493 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11494 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11495 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11496 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11497 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11498 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11499 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11501 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11502 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11503 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11504 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11506 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11507 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11508 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11511 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11512 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11513 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11514 following are true:
11517 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11519 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11520 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11521 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11523 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11524 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11525 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11527 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11528 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11529 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11531 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11532 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11533 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11534 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11536 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11538 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11539 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11543 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11544 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11545 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11546 number that was used on the remote host.
11548 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11549 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11550 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11551 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11552 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11555 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11556 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11557 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11558 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11560 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11561 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11562 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11563 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11564 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11565 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11566 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11567 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11568 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11569 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11570 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11573 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11574 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11575 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11576 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11577 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11579 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11580 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11581 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11582 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11583 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11585 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11586 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11587 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11588 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11589 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11590 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11591 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11593 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11594 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11595 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11596 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11597 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11599 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11600 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11601 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11602 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11603 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11604 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11606 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11607 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11608 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11609 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11610 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11615 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11616 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11617 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11618 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11620 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11621 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11622 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11623 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11624 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11625 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11626 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11628 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11629 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11630 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11631 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11632 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11633 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11634 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11635 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11636 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11637 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11638 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11640 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11641 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11642 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11643 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11644 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11645 message is junk mail.
11647 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11648 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11649 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11650 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11653 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
11654 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11655 The name of Exim's spool directory.
11657 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11658 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11659 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11660 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11661 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11662 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11664 .vitem &$spool_space$&
11665 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11666 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11667 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11668 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11669 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11670 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11671 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11673 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11675 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11678 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
11679 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11680 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11681 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11682 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11683 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11685 .vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
11686 .vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
11687 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
11688 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
11690 .vitem &$tls_cipher$&
11691 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
11692 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11693 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
11694 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
11695 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
11696 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
11697 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
11699 The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
11700 when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
11701 case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
11702 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
11703 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
11704 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
11706 .vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
11707 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
11708 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11709 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
11710 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
11711 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
11712 value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
11715 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
11716 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
11717 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
11718 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
11720 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
11721 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
11722 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11724 .vitem &$tod_full$&
11725 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
11726 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
11727 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
11728 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
11729 values for those that are behind (west).
11732 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
11733 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
11734 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
11736 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
11737 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
11738 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
11739 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
11742 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
11743 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
11744 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
11747 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
11748 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
11749 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
11750 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
11753 .vindex "&$value$&"
11754 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
11755 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
11756 &*reduce*& expansion.
11758 .vitem &$version_number$&
11759 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
11760 The version number of Exim.
11762 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
11763 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
11764 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11765 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11767 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
11768 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
11769 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11770 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11776 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11777 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11779 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
11780 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
11781 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
11782 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
11783 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
11784 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
11789 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
11792 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
11793 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
11794 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
11795 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
11796 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
11797 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
11798 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
11799 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
11800 a newly created Perl interpreter.
11802 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
11803 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
11804 should usually be something like
11806 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
11808 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
11809 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
11810 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
11811 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
11812 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
11813 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
11814 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
11815 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
11819 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
11820 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
11821 a startup when Exim is entered.
11823 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
11824 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
11827 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
11828 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
11831 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
11832 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
11833 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
11834 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
11838 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
11839 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
11841 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
11842 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
11843 with an error message of the form
11845 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
11847 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
11848 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
11849 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
11850 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
11851 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
11852 that was passed to &%die%&.
11855 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
11856 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
11857 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
11860 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
11862 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
11863 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
11864 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
11866 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
11867 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
11868 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
11869 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
11871 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
11872 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
11873 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
11874 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
11875 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
11876 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
11877 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
11880 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
11881 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
11882 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
11883 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
11884 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
11885 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
11886 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
11887 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
11888 avoided, but the output is lost.
11890 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
11891 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
11892 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
11893 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
11894 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
11895 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
11896 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
11898 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
11900 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
11901 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
11902 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
11903 as the first subroutine argument.
11907 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11908 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11910 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
11911 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
11912 "Starting the daemon"
11913 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
11914 .cindex "interface" "listening"
11915 .cindex "network interface"
11916 .cindex "interface" "network"
11917 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
11918 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
11919 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
11920 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
11921 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
11922 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
11923 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
11924 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
11925 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
11926 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
11927 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
11930 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
11931 and ports to listen on.
11933 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
11934 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
11935 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
11936 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
11937 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
11938 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
11939 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
11940 as an error situation.
11942 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
11943 for the outgoing connection.
11947 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
11948 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
11949 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
11950 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
11951 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
11953 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
11954 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
11955 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
11956 chapter describes how they operate.
11958 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
11959 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
11963 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
11964 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
11965 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
11969 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
11970 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
11972 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
11973 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
11976 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
11977 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
11978 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
11979 colons. For example:
11981 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
11984 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
11986 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
11987 in &%local_interfaces%&:
11990 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
11991 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
11993 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
11994 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
11997 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
11998 with a colon separator, for example:
12000 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12001 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12005 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12006 default setting contains just one port:
12008 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12010 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12011 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12012 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12013 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12014 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12018 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12019 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12020 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12021 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12022 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12023 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12025 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12027 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12029 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12031 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12035 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12036 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12037 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12038 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12039 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12040 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12043 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12044 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12045 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12046 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12047 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12048 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12052 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12055 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12057 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12058 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12059 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12063 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12064 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12065 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12066 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12067 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12068 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12069 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12070 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12071 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12072 common use of this option is expected to be
12074 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12076 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12077 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12078 this way when a daemon is started.
12080 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12081 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12082 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12083 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12084 connections via the daemon.)
12089 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12090 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12091 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12092 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12093 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12094 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12095 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12096 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12098 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12100 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12101 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12102 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12103 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12104 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12105 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12107 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12109 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12110 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12111 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12112 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12113 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12115 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12116 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12117 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12118 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12119 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12120 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12121 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12122 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12123 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12124 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12125 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12126 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12128 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12129 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12130 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12131 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12132 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12136 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12137 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12139 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12140 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12142 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12143 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12144 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12145 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12147 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12149 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12151 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12153 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12154 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12156 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12157 IPv4 loopback address only:
12159 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12161 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12163 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12165 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12169 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12170 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12171 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12172 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12175 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12176 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12177 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12178 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12180 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12181 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12182 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12183 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12184 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12185 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12186 used for listening. Consider this example:
12188 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12190 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12192 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12194 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12195 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12198 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12199 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12200 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12201 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12202 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12203 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12204 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12205 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12209 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12210 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12211 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12212 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12213 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12214 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12220 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12221 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12223 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12224 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12225 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12226 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12229 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12230 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12232 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12233 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12234 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12236 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12237 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12238 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12239 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12243 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12244 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12245 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12246 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12247 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12248 listed in more than one group.
12250 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12252 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12253 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12254 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12255 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12256 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12257 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12258 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12259 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12260 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12264 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12266 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12267 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12268 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12269 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12270 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12271 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12276 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12278 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12279 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12280 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12281 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12282 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12283 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12284 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12285 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12286 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12287 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12288 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12293 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12295 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12296 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12297 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12298 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12299 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12300 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12301 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12302 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12303 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12304 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12305 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12306 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12311 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12313 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12314 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12315 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12316 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12321 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12323 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12324 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12325 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12326 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12327 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12328 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12329 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12330 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12335 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12337 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12338 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12343 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12345 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12346 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12351 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12353 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12354 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12355 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12356 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12357 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12358 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12359 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12364 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12366 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12367 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12368 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12369 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12370 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12371 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12372 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12373 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12374 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12375 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12376 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12377 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12378 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12379 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12380 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12381 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12383 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12384 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12385 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12386 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12387 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12392 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12394 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12395 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12396 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12397 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12398 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12399 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12400 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
12401 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12402 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12403 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12404 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12405 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12406 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12407 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12408 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12409 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12410 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12411 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12412 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12413 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12415 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12416 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12417 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12418 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12419 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12420 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12421 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12422 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12423 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12424 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12425 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12426 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12427 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12428 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12429 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12430 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12431 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12432 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12437 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12439 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12441 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12443 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12444 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12445 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12450 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12452 .row &%gnutls_require_kx%& "control GnuTLS key exchanges"
12453 .row &%gnutls_require_mac%& "control GnuTLS MAC algorithms"
12454 .row &%gnutls_require_protocols%& "control GnuTLS protocols"
12455 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
12456 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
12457 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12458 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12459 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12460 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12461 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12462 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12463 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12464 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12465 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12466 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12467 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12472 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12474 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12475 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12476 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12477 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12478 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12479 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12480 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12481 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12486 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12488 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12489 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12490 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12491 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12492 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12493 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12494 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12495 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12501 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12503 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12510 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12511 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12514 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12515 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12516 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12517 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12518 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12519 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12520 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12521 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12522 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12523 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12524 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12525 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12526 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12527 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12529 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12530 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12531 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12532 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12533 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12534 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12535 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12536 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12537 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12538 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12539 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12540 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12541 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12542 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12543 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12544 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12549 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12551 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12552 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12553 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12554 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12555 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12556 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12561 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12563 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12564 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12565 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12566 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12568 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12569 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12570 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12571 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12572 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12573 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12574 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12575 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12576 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12577 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12582 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
12584 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12585 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12587 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12588 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12589 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12590 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12591 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12596 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12598 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12599 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12600 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12601 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12602 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12603 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12604 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12605 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12606 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12607 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12608 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12609 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12610 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12611 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12612 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12613 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12614 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12615 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12616 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12617 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12618 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
12623 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
12625 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
12626 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
12627 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
12628 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
12629 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
12630 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
12631 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
12632 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
12633 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
12634 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
12635 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
12636 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
12637 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12638 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
12643 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
12644 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
12647 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean false
12649 .cindex "8-bit characters"
12650 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
12651 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
12652 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
12653 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
12654 Consequently, this option is turned off by default.
12656 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
12657 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
12658 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12659 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
12660 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12663 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12664 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
12665 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
12668 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
12669 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
12670 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12671 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
12672 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12674 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
12675 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
12676 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
12677 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
12678 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12680 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
12681 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
12682 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
12683 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12685 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
12686 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
12687 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
12688 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
12689 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12691 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
12692 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
12693 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
12694 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12696 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
12697 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
12698 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
12699 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12701 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
12702 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
12703 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
12704 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
12705 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12708 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
12709 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
12710 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
12711 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12713 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
12714 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12715 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
12716 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
12717 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
12719 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12720 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
12721 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
12722 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
12723 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
12725 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
12726 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
12727 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12730 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
12731 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
12732 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
12733 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12735 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
12736 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
12737 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
12738 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12740 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
12741 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
12742 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
12743 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12745 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
12746 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
12747 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
12748 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12750 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
12751 .cindex "admin user"
12752 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
12753 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
12754 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
12755 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
12756 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
12757 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
12758 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
12760 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
12761 .cindex "domain literal"
12762 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
12763 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
12764 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
12765 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
12767 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
12768 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
12769 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
12770 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
12771 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
12772 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
12773 the local host's IP addresses.
12776 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
12777 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
12778 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
12779 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
12780 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
12781 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
12782 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
12783 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
12784 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
12786 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
12787 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
12788 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
12789 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
12790 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
12791 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
12792 experiment if they wish.
12794 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
12795 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
12796 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
12797 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
12798 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
12799 suitable setting is:
12801 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
12802 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
12804 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
12806 dns_check_names_pattern =
12808 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
12811 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
12812 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
12813 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
12814 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
12815 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
12816 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
12817 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
12818 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
12819 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
12820 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
12821 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
12823 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
12824 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
12825 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
12826 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
12827 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
12828 which Exim advertises AUTH.
12830 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
12831 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
12832 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
12833 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
12835 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
12837 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12838 If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
12839 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
12840 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
12843 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
12844 .cindex "thawing messages"
12845 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
12846 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
12847 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
12848 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
12849 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
12850 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
12852 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
12853 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
12854 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
12856 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
12857 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
12858 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
12860 sophie:/var/run/sophie
12862 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
12863 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
12867 .option bi_command main string unset
12869 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
12870 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
12871 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
12872 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
12875 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
12876 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
12877 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
12878 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
12879 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
12880 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
12883 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
12884 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
12885 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
12886 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
12888 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
12889 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
12890 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
12891 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
12892 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
12893 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
12894 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
12895 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
12896 point at which the error was detected are returned.
12897 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
12899 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
12900 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
12901 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
12902 &%bounce_return_body%&.
12905 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
12906 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
12907 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
12908 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
12909 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
12910 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
12911 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
12912 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
12913 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
12915 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
12916 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
12917 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
12918 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
12919 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
12922 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
12923 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
12924 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
12925 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
12926 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
12927 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
12928 connection. A typical setting might be:
12930 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12932 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
12934 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12936 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
12939 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
12940 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
12941 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
12942 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
12943 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12944 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12947 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
12948 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
12949 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12950 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12953 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
12954 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
12955 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12956 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12959 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
12960 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
12961 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12962 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12965 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
12966 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
12967 callout verification. The default value is
12969 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
12971 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
12974 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
12975 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12978 .option check_log_space main integer 0
12979 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12981 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
12982 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
12983 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
12984 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
12985 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
12986 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
12987 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
12988 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
12989 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
12990 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
12993 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
12994 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12997 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
12998 .cindex "checking disk space"
12999 .cindex "disk space, checking"
13000 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13001 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13002 message is accepted.
13004 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13005 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13006 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13007 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13008 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13009 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13010 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13011 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13014 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13015 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13017 check_spool_space = 10M
13018 check_spool_inodes = 100
13020 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13021 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13024 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13025 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13026 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13028 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13029 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13030 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13031 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13032 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13033 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13035 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13036 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13038 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13039 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13040 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13042 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13043 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13044 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13045 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13046 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13047 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13049 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13050 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13051 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13052 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13053 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13054 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13055 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13057 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13058 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13060 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13061 .cindex "warning of delay"
13062 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13063 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13064 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13065 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13066 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13067 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13068 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13071 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13073 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13074 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13075 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13076 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13080 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13081 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13083 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13086 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13087 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13088 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13089 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13090 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13091 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13092 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13093 not sent. The default is:
13095 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13096 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13097 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13098 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13101 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13102 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13103 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13104 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13106 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13107 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13108 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13109 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13110 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13111 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13112 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13113 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13115 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13116 .cindex "load average"
13117 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13118 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13119 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13120 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13121 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13124 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13125 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13126 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13127 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13128 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13129 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13130 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13131 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13133 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13134 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13135 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13136 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13137 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13138 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13139 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13140 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13142 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13143 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13144 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13145 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13148 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13149 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13150 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13151 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13152 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13153 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13154 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13157 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13158 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13159 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13160 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13161 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13162 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13163 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13164 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13165 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13166 by a setting such as this:
13168 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13170 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13171 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13172 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13173 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13174 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13175 options are applied after this global option.
13177 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13178 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13179 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13180 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13181 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13182 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13183 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13184 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13185 value of this option. The default pattern is
13187 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13188 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13190 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13191 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13192 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13193 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13194 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13197 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13198 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13199 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13201 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13202 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13203 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13204 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13206 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13207 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13208 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13209 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13210 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13211 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13212 domain matches this list.
13214 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13215 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13216 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13219 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13220 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13221 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13222 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13223 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13224 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13225 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13226 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13227 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13228 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13232 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13233 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13236 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13237 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13238 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13239 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13241 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13242 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13243 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13244 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13245 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13246 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13248 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13250 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13251 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13253 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13254 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13255 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13256 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13257 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13258 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13259 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13260 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13261 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13264 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13265 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13266 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13267 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13268 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13269 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13270 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13271 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13272 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13274 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13275 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13276 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13277 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13278 are examined. For example:
13280 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13281 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13282 postmaster@mydomain.example
13284 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13285 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13286 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13287 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13288 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13289 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13290 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13293 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13294 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13295 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13297 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13299 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13300 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13301 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13302 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13303 overrides the default.
13305 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13306 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13307 and warning messages. For example:
13309 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13311 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13312 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13313 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13314 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13318 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13319 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13320 .cindex "Exim group"
13321 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13322 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13323 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13324 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13325 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13329 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13330 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13331 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13332 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13333 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13334 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13336 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13337 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13338 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13339 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13342 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13343 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13344 .cindex "Exim user"
13345 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13346 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13347 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13348 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13350 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13351 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13352 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13353 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13356 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13357 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13358 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13359 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13362 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13363 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13365 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13366 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13368 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13369 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13370 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13371 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13372 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13373 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13374 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13375 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13376 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13377 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13381 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13382 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13383 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13384 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13385 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13386 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13387 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13388 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13391 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13392 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13393 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13394 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13398 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13399 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13400 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13401 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13402 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13403 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13404 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13405 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13406 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13407 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13408 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13409 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13410 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13411 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13412 logging that you require.
13415 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13417 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13418 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13419 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13420 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13421 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13422 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13423 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13424 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13426 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13427 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13428 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13431 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13432 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13433 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13434 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13436 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13440 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13441 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13444 .option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
13445 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13446 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13448 .option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
13449 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13450 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13452 .option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
13453 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13454 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13456 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
13457 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
13458 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
13459 implementations of TLS.
13461 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13462 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13463 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13464 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13465 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13466 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13470 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13471 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13472 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13473 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13474 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13475 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13476 sections are rejected.
13479 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13480 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13481 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13482 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13483 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13484 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13485 zero means &"no limit"&.
13490 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13491 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13492 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13493 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13494 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13495 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13496 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13497 if you want to do semantic checking.
13498 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13502 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13503 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13504 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13505 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13506 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13507 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13508 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13510 helo_allow_chars = _
13512 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13515 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13516 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13517 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13518 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13519 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13520 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13521 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13525 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13526 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13527 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13528 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13529 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13530 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13531 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13532 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13533 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13534 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
13535 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13536 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13538 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13539 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13540 EHLO command either:
13543 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13545 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13546 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13547 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13548 calling host address, or
13550 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13551 available) yields the calling host address.
13554 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13555 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13556 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
13558 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13559 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13560 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13561 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13562 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13563 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13564 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13565 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13566 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13569 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13570 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13571 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13572 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13573 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13574 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13575 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13576 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13577 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13579 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13580 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13581 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13582 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13583 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13585 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13586 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13587 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13588 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13591 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13592 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13593 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13594 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13595 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13596 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13597 default configuration file contains
13601 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13602 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13604 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
13605 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
13606 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
13608 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13609 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13610 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
13611 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
13612 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
13613 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
13616 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
13617 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
13618 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
13619 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
13620 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
13623 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
13624 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
13625 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
13626 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
13630 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
13631 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
13632 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
13633 as soon as the connection is made.
13634 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
13635 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
13636 connections immediately.
13638 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
13639 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
13640 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
13641 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
13642 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
13645 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
13646 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
13647 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
13648 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
13649 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
13650 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
13651 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
13652 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
13653 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
13655 hosts_connection_nolog = :
13657 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
13661 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
13662 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
13663 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
13664 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
13665 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
13667 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
13668 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
13670 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
13671 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
13672 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
13673 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
13674 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
13675 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
13676 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
13679 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
13680 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
13681 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
13682 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13683 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
13687 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
13688 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
13689 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
13690 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
13691 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
13692 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
13694 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
13695 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
13696 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
13697 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
13698 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
13699 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
13700 for frozen messages. For example,
13702 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
13704 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
13705 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
13706 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
13707 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
13708 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
13709 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
13712 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13713 .cindex "&""From""& line"
13714 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
13715 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
13716 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
13717 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
13718 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
13719 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
13720 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
13721 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
13724 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
13725 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
13728 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
13729 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
13730 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
13731 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
13735 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
13736 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
13737 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
13738 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
13739 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
13743 .option ldap_version main integer unset
13744 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
13745 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
13746 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
13747 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
13748 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
13749 has been built with LDAP support.
13753 .option local_from_check main boolean true
13754 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
13755 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
13756 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13757 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
13758 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
13759 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
13761 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
13762 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
13763 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
13765 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
13766 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
13767 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
13768 and the default qualify domain.
13770 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
13771 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
13772 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
13773 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
13775 .cindex "envelope sender"
13776 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
13777 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
13778 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
13780 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
13781 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
13782 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13787 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
13788 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
13789 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
13790 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
13791 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
13792 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
13793 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
13796 local_from_prefix = *-
13798 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
13800 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
13802 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
13803 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
13807 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
13808 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
13811 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
13812 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
13813 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
13814 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
13815 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
13816 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
13817 &%local_interfaces%& is
13819 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13821 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
13823 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13826 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
13827 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
13828 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
13829 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
13830 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
13831 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
13832 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
13833 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
13837 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
13838 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
13839 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13840 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
13841 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
13842 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
13843 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
13844 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13849 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
13850 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
13851 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
13852 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13853 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
13854 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
13855 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
13856 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
13857 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
13858 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
13859 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
13860 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
13861 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
13862 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
13863 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
13867 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
13868 .cindex "log" "file path for"
13869 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
13870 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
13871 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
13872 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
13873 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
13874 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
13875 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
13876 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
13877 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
13878 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
13879 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
13880 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
13883 .option log_selector main string unset
13884 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13885 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
13886 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
13887 minus characters. For example:
13889 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
13891 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
13892 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
13895 .option log_timezone main boolean false
13896 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
13897 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13898 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13899 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
13900 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
13901 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
13902 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
13903 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
13904 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
13905 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
13906 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
13907 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
13910 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
13911 .cindex "too many open files"
13912 .cindex "open files, too many"
13913 .cindex "file" "too many open"
13914 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
13915 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
13916 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
13917 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
13918 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
13919 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
13920 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
13921 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
13922 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
13923 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
13924 &%lookup_open_max%&.
13927 .option max_username_length main integer 0
13928 .cindex "length of login name"
13929 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
13930 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
13931 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
13932 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
13933 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
13934 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
13937 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
13938 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
13939 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
13940 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13941 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13942 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
13943 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
13944 option is set true, this no longer happens.
13947 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
13948 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
13949 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
13950 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13951 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13952 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
13953 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
13956 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
13957 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
13958 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
13959 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
13960 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
13961 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
13962 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
13963 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
13964 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
13965 empty string, the option is ignored.
13968 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
13969 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
13970 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
13971 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
13972 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
13973 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
13974 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
13975 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
13976 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
13977 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
13978 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
13979 colons will become hyphens.
13982 .option message_logs main boolean true
13983 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
13984 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
13985 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
13986 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
13987 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
13988 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
13989 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
13990 which is not affected by this option.
13993 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
13994 .cindex "message" "size limit"
13995 .cindex "limit" "message size"
13996 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
13997 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
13998 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
13999 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14000 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14001 optionally followed by K or M.
14003 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14004 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14005 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14006 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14007 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14009 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14010 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14011 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14012 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14013 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14014 message that an individual transport can process.
14016 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14017 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14018 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14019 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14020 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14021 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14022 some problems may result.
14025 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14026 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14027 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14029 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14031 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14032 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14033 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14034 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14035 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14038 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14039 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14040 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14041 contains a full description of this facility.
14045 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14046 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14047 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14048 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14049 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14052 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14053 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14054 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14055 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14056 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14059 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14060 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14061 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14062 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14063 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14065 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14066 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14069 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14071 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14072 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14076 .option openssl_options main "string list" +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14077 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14078 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14079 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14080 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value. The default
14081 value is one option which happens to have been set historically. You can
14082 remove all options with:
14084 openssl_options = -all
14086 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14087 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14088 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14089 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14090 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14091 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14092 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14094 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14095 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14096 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14097 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at by invoking Exim
14098 with the &%-bV%& flag.
14102 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer
14106 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14107 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14108 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14109 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14110 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14113 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14114 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14115 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14116 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14117 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14118 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14119 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14120 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14121 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14122 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14125 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14126 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14127 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14128 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14129 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14130 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14131 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14134 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14135 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14136 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14139 .option perl_startup main string unset
14140 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14141 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14144 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14145 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14146 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14147 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14148 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14149 PostgreSQL support.
14152 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14153 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14154 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14155 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14156 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14159 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14161 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14163 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14164 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14165 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14168 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14169 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14170 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14171 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14172 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14173 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14174 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14175 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14176 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14179 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14180 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14181 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14182 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14183 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14184 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14185 volume of mail. Use with care!
14188 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14189 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14190 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14191 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14192 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14193 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14194 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14195 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14196 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14197 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14199 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14200 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14201 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14202 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14203 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14204 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14207 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14208 .cindex "printing characters"
14209 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14210 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14211 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14212 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14213 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14214 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14217 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14218 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14219 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14220 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14221 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14225 .option process_log_path main string unset
14226 .cindex "process log path"
14227 .cindex "log" "process log"
14228 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14229 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14230 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14231 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14232 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14233 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14234 different spool directories.
14237 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14241 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14242 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14243 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14246 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14247 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14248 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14249 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14250 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14251 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14252 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14253 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14254 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14256 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14257 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14258 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14259 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14260 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14261 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14262 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14265 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14266 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14267 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14271 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14272 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14273 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14274 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14275 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14276 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14277 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14278 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14281 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14283 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14284 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14285 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14288 .option queue_only main boolean false
14289 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14290 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14291 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14292 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14293 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14294 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14296 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14297 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14298 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14299 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14302 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14303 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14304 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14305 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14306 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14307 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14308 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14309 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14310 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14312 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14314 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14315 &_/some/file_& exists.
14318 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14319 .cindex "load average"
14320 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14321 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14322 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14323 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14324 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14325 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14326 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14329 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14330 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14331 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14332 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14335 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14336 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14337 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14338 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14339 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14340 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14341 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14342 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14343 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14344 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14345 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14346 re-evaluated for each message.
14349 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14350 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14351 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14352 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14353 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14354 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14357 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14358 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14359 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14360 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14361 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14362 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14363 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14364 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14365 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14366 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14367 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14368 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14369 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14373 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14374 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14375 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14376 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14377 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14378 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14379 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14380 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14381 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14383 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14384 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14385 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14386 the daemon's command line.
14388 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14389 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14390 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14391 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14392 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14393 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14394 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14395 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14396 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14397 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14398 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14399 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14400 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14404 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
14405 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14406 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14407 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14408 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14409 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14410 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14412 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14413 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14414 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14415 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14416 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14417 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14418 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14419 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14420 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14421 header lines. The default setting is:
14424 received_header_text = Received: \
14425 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14426 {${if def:sender_ident \
14427 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14428 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14429 by $primary_hostname \
14430 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14431 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
14432 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14433 ${if def:sender_address \
14434 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14435 id $message_exim_id\
14436 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14439 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14440 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14441 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14442 header lines such as the following:
14444 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14445 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14446 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14447 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14448 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14449 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14450 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14452 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14453 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14454 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14455 message was accepted.
14458 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
14459 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
14460 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
14461 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14462 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14463 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14464 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14465 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14468 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14469 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14470 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14471 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14472 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14473 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14474 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14475 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14476 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14477 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14478 option was not set.
14481 .option recipients_max main integer 0
14482 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14483 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
14484 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
14485 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
14486 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
14487 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
14488 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
14491 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
14492 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
14493 RCPT commands in a single message.
14496 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
14497 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
14498 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
14499 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
14500 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
14501 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
14502 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
14505 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
14506 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
14507 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
14508 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
14509 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
14510 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
14511 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
14512 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
14513 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
14514 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
14515 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
14516 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
14517 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
14518 tagged with its process id.
14520 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
14521 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
14522 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
14523 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
14526 .cindex "number of deliveries"
14527 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
14528 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
14529 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
14530 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
14531 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
14532 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
14533 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
14534 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
14535 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
14536 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
14538 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
14539 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
14540 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
14541 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
14544 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14545 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
14546 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
14547 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
14548 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
14550 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
14552 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
14553 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
14556 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
14557 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
14558 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
14559 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
14560 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
14564 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
14565 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
14566 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
14567 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
14568 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
14569 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
14570 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
14574 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
14575 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
14576 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
14577 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
14578 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
14579 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
14580 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
14581 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
14582 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
14583 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
14586 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
14587 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14590 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14592 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
14593 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
14596 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
14597 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
14598 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
14599 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
14600 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
14603 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14604 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14605 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14606 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14607 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
14608 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
14609 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
14610 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
14611 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
14612 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
14615 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
14616 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
14617 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
14618 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
14619 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
14620 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
14621 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
14622 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
14623 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
14624 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
14625 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
14629 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
14630 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
14631 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14633 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
14634 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
14635 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
14636 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
14637 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
14638 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14640 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
14641 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
14642 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
14643 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
14646 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
14647 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
14648 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
14649 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
14650 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
14651 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
14652 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
14653 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
14655 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
14656 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
14657 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
14658 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
14659 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
14660 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
14661 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
14662 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
14665 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14666 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
14667 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
14668 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
14672 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14673 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14675 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
14676 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
14677 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
14678 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
14679 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
14680 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
14681 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
14682 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
14683 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
14687 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
14688 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
14689 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
14690 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
14691 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
14692 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
14693 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
14694 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
14695 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
14696 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
14697 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
14699 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
14700 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
14701 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
14702 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
14703 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
14704 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
14708 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
14709 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14710 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14711 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
14712 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
14713 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
14714 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
14715 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
14716 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
14717 to all messages received in the same connection.
14719 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
14720 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
14721 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
14722 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
14725 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14726 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14728 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
14729 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
14730 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14731 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
14732 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
14733 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
14734 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
14735 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
14736 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
14737 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
14738 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
14739 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
14740 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
14743 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
14744 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
14745 .cindex "host" "reserved"
14746 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
14747 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
14748 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
14749 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
14750 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
14751 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
14752 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
14753 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
14756 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
14757 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
14758 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
14759 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
14762 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
14763 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
14764 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
14765 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14766 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
14767 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
14768 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
14769 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
14770 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
14772 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
14773 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
14774 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
14775 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
14777 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
14778 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
14779 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
14780 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
14781 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
14784 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
14785 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
14788 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
14789 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
14790 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
14791 &%helo_data%& value.
14793 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
14794 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
14795 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
14796 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
14797 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
14798 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
14799 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
14801 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
14802 $version_number $tod_full
14804 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
14805 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
14806 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
14807 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
14808 multiline response).
14811 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
14812 .cindex "checking disk space"
14813 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14814 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14815 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
14816 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
14817 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
14818 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
14819 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
14822 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
14823 .cindex "connection backlog"
14824 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
14825 .cindex "backlog of connections"
14826 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
14827 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
14828 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
14829 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
14830 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
14831 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
14832 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
14833 attacks by SYN flooding.
14836 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
14837 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
14838 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
14839 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
14840 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
14841 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
14842 fewer, but they still exist.
14844 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
14845 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
14846 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
14847 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
14848 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
14849 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
14850 does detect many instances.
14852 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
14853 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
14854 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
14855 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
14859 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
14860 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
14861 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14862 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
14863 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
14864 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
14865 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
14866 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
14869 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
14870 $sender_host_address
14872 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
14873 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
14874 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
14875 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
14876 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
14880 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
14881 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
14882 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
14883 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
14884 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
14887 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
14888 .cindex "load average"
14889 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
14890 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
14891 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
14892 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
14893 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
14894 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
14898 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
14899 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
14900 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
14901 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
14902 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
14904 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
14906 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
14907 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
14908 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
14909 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
14910 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
14912 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
14913 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
14914 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
14915 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
14916 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
14917 not count towards the limit.
14921 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
14922 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
14923 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
14924 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
14925 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
14928 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
14929 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
14933 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14934 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
14935 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
14936 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
14937 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
14938 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
14941 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
14942 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
14943 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
14944 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
14946 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
14947 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
14948 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
14949 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
14953 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
14955 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
14956 fractional parts are allowed here.
14958 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
14960 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
14961 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
14964 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
14965 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
14967 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
14968 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
14970 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
14971 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
14972 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
14973 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
14976 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
14977 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14980 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
14981 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14984 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
14985 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
14986 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
14987 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
14988 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
14989 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
14990 the message is abandoned.
14991 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
14993 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
14994 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
14996 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
14997 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
15001 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
15002 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15003 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15004 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15005 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15008 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15009 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15010 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15013 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15014 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15015 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15016 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15017 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15018 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15019 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15020 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15021 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15022 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15024 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15025 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15028 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
15029 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15030 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15031 The default value is
15035 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15039 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15040 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
15041 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
15042 .cindex "directories, multiple"
15043 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15044 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15045 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15046 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15047 arrival of the message.
15049 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15050 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15051 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15052 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15053 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15055 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15056 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15057 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15058 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15059 automatically deleted.
15061 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15062 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15063 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15064 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15065 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15066 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15067 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15068 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15069 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15072 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15073 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15074 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15075 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15076 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15077 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15078 &$primary_hostname$&.
15080 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15081 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15082 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15083 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15084 as failures in the configuration file.
15086 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15087 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15089 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15090 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15091 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15092 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15094 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15095 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15096 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15097 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15098 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15099 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15101 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15102 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15103 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15104 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15105 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15106 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15107 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15110 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15111 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15112 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15113 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15114 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15115 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15116 domain causes a syntax error.
15117 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15121 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15122 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15123 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15124 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15125 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15126 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15127 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15128 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15129 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15130 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15131 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15132 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15135 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15136 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15137 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15138 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15139 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15140 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15141 details of Exim's logging.
15145 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15146 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15147 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15148 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15149 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15153 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15154 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15155 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15156 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15157 details of Exim's logging.
15160 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15161 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15162 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15163 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15164 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15165 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15166 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15167 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15168 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15169 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15170 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15173 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15174 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15175 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15176 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15177 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15178 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15181 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15182 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15183 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15184 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15185 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15187 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15188 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15189 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15190 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15191 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15193 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15194 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15195 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15196 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15197 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15198 contains the pipe command.
15201 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15202 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15203 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15204 is used in a system filter.
15206 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15207 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15208 If this option is not set, the system filter is run in the main Exim delivery
15209 process, as root. When the option is set, the system filter runs in a separate
15210 process, as the given user. Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15211 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15212 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15213 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15214 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15216 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15217 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15218 transport option overrides. Normally you should set &%system_filter_user%& if
15219 your system filter generates these kinds of delivery.
15222 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15223 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15224 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15225 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15226 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15227 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15228 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15229 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15230 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15231 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15232 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15233 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15237 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15238 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15239 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15240 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15241 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15242 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15243 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15244 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15245 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15246 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15248 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15249 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15250 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15253 .option timezone main string unset
15254 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15255 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15256 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15257 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15258 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15262 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15263 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15264 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15265 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15266 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15267 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15270 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15271 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15272 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15273 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15274 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15275 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15276 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15277 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15280 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15281 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15282 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15283 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15284 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15285 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15286 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15288 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15289 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15290 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15291 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15294 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15295 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15296 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15297 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15298 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15301 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15302 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15303 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15304 a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
15305 This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
15306 ignored. See section &<<SECTopenvsgnu>>& for further details.
15309 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15310 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15311 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15312 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15313 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15317 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15318 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15319 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15320 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15321 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15322 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15323 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15326 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15327 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15328 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15329 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15330 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15331 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15335 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15336 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15337 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15338 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15339 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15340 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15341 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15342 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15343 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15344 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15345 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15348 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15349 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15350 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15351 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15354 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15355 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15356 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15357 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15358 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15359 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15360 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15361 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15362 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15365 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15366 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15367 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15368 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15369 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15370 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15371 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15372 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15374 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15375 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15376 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15377 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15378 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15379 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15380 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15382 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15383 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15384 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15385 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15386 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15387 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15388 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15391 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15395 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15396 .cindex "trusted groups"
15397 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
15398 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15399 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15400 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15401 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15402 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15403 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15406 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15407 .cindex "trusted users"
15408 .cindex "user" "trusted"
15409 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15410 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15411 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15412 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
15413 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
15414 Exim user are trusted.
15416 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
15417 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
15418 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
15419 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
15420 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
15421 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
15422 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
15423 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
15424 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
15427 .option unknown_username main string unset
15428 See &%unknown_login%&.
15430 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
15431 .cindex "trusted users"
15432 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
15433 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
15434 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
15435 .cindex "envelope sender"
15436 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
15437 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
15438 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
15439 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
15440 is used) is ignored.
15442 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
15443 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
15445 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
15447 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
15448 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
15449 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
15450 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
15451 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
15452 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
15453 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
15454 followed by a hyphen
15455 by a setting like this:
15457 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
15459 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
15460 restriction, you can use
15462 untrusted_set_sender = *
15464 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
15465 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
15466 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
15467 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
15468 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
15469 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
15470 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
15471 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
15473 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
15474 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
15475 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
15476 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
15480 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
15481 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15482 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15483 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
15484 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
15485 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
15486 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
15487 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
15488 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
15489 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
15491 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
15492 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
15494 The pattern can be seen by running
15496 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
15498 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
15499 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
15500 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
15501 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
15502 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
15503 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
15506 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
15507 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
15510 .option warn_message_file main string unset
15511 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
15512 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
15513 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15514 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
15515 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
15516 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
15517 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
15520 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
15521 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
15522 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
15523 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
15524 .ecindex IIDconfima
15525 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
15530 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15531 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15533 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
15534 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
15535 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
15536 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
15537 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
15539 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
15540 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
15541 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
15542 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
15543 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
15547 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
15548 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
15549 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
15550 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
15551 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
15552 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
15553 delivery of the address to be deferred.
15555 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15556 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
15557 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
15558 routers, and the eventual transport.
15560 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
15561 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
15562 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
15563 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
15564 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
15566 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
15567 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
15568 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
15569 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
15570 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
15572 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
15573 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
15574 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
15576 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
15578 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
15580 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
15582 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
15583 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
15585 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
15586 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15587 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
15588 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
15589 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
15590 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
15591 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
15595 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
15597 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
15598 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
15599 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
15600 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
15601 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
15606 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
15607 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
15608 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
15609 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
15610 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
15611 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
15612 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
15613 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
15614 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
15615 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
15618 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
15620 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
15623 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
15625 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
15626 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
15627 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
15628 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
15631 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
15632 .cindex "case of local parts"
15633 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
15634 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
15635 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
15636 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
15637 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
15638 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
15639 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
15642 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15643 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
15644 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
15645 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
15646 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
15647 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
15648 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
15649 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
15650 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
15652 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
15653 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
15654 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
15655 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
15659 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
15660 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
15661 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
15662 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
15664 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
15665 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
15666 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
15667 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
15668 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
15669 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
15670 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
15671 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
15672 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
15673 the router is skipped.
15675 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
15676 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
15677 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
15678 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
15679 setting to achieve this. For example:
15681 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
15683 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
15684 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
15685 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
15689 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
15690 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
15691 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
15692 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
15693 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
15694 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
15695 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
15696 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
15698 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
15699 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
15701 This option is unique in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
15702 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
15704 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
15705 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
15706 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
15708 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15710 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
15712 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
15714 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
15716 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15717 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
15720 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
15721 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
15722 be specified using &%condition%&.
15726 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
15727 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
15728 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
15729 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
15730 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
15731 output, and Exim carries on processing.
15732 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
15733 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
15734 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
15735 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
15736 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
15737 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
15741 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
15742 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
15743 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
15744 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
15745 transport option of the same name.
15748 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
15749 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
15750 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
15751 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
15752 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
15753 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
15754 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
15755 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
15759 .option driver routers string unset
15760 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
15765 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
15766 .cindex "envelope sender"
15767 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
15768 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
15769 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
15770 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
15771 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
15772 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
15773 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
15775 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
15776 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
15777 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
15780 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
15781 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
15782 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
15783 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
15785 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
15786 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
15787 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
15788 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
15794 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
15795 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
15796 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
15797 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
15798 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
15800 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15801 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
15802 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
15803 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
15804 setting &%return_path%&.
15806 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
15807 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
15808 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
15812 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
15813 .cindex "address" "testing"
15814 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
15815 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
15816 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
15817 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
15818 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
15819 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
15820 on for the system alias file.
15821 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
15824 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
15825 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
15826 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
15830 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
15831 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
15832 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
15833 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
15837 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
15838 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15839 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
15843 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
15844 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15845 verifying a sender, verification fails.
15849 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
15850 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
15851 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
15852 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
15853 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
15854 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
15855 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
15856 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
15857 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
15859 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
15860 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
15861 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
15862 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
15863 transport for further details.
15866 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
15867 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
15868 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15869 .cindex "transport" "local"
15870 .cindex "router" "setting group"
15871 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
15872 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
15874 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
15875 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
15876 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
15877 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
15878 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15882 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
15883 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
15884 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
15885 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15886 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15887 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15888 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
15889 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
15890 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
15891 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
15892 &"see"& the added header lines.
15894 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
15895 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
15896 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
15897 failures are treated as configuration errors.
15899 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15900 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15902 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
15903 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
15904 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15905 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
15906 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
15907 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
15908 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
15909 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
15910 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
15911 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
15915 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
15916 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
15917 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
15918 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15919 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15920 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15921 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
15922 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
15923 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
15924 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
15925 &"see"& the original header lines.
15927 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
15928 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
15929 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
15932 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15933 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15935 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15936 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
15937 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
15938 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
15941 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
15942 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
15943 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
15944 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
15945 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
15946 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
15947 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
15950 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
15954 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
15956 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
15957 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
15958 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
15959 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
15960 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
15961 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
15963 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
15964 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
15966 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
15967 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
15969 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
15970 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
15972 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
15973 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
15974 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
15975 domain that is being routed.
15977 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
15978 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
15981 .option initgroups routers boolean false
15982 .cindex "additional groups"
15983 .cindex "groups" "additional"
15984 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15985 .cindex "transport" "local"
15986 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
15987 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
15988 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
15989 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
15990 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15994 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
15995 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
15996 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
15997 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
15998 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
15999 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
16002 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16003 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16004 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16005 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16006 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16007 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16008 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16009 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16010 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16012 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16013 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16014 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16015 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16016 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16017 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16018 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16019 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16020 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16021 the relevant transport.
16023 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16024 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16025 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16028 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16029 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16030 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16031 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16032 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16036 local_part_prefix = real-
16038 transport = local_delivery
16040 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16041 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16043 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16044 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16047 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16048 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16049 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16050 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16053 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16054 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16058 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16059 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16060 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16061 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16062 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16063 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16064 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16065 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16066 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16070 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16071 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16075 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16076 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16077 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16078 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16079 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16081 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16082 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16085 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16087 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16088 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16089 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16090 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16091 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16092 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16093 each virtual domain:
16097 local_parts = postmaster
16098 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16102 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16103 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
16104 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16105 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16106 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16107 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16108 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16109 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16110 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16111 redirect addresses.
16115 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16116 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16117 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16118 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16119 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16120 delivery to be deferred.
16122 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16123 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16125 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16126 means of the setting
16130 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16131 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16132 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16134 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16135 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16136 controls what happens next.
16139 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16140 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16141 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16142 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16143 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16144 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16145 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16146 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16148 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16149 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16150 applies to all of them.
16154 .option pass_router routers string unset
16155 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16156 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16157 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16158 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16159 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16160 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16161 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16162 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16163 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16164 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16168 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16169 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16170 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16171 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16172 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16173 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16175 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16176 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16177 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16178 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16182 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16183 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16184 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16185 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16186 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16187 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16188 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16190 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16191 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16192 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16193 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16195 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16196 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16197 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16198 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16199 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16202 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16203 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16206 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16207 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16208 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16209 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16210 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16211 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16212 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16213 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16215 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16216 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16217 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16218 operates as follows:
16220 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16221 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16222 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16223 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16226 require_files = mail:/some/file
16227 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16229 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16230 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16232 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16233 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16234 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16235 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16237 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16238 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16239 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16240 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16241 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16243 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16244 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16245 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16246 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16247 check again in that process.
16249 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16250 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16251 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16252 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16253 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16254 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16255 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16257 require_files = +/some/file
16259 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16260 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16261 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16265 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16266 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16267 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16268 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16269 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16270 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16271 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16272 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16275 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16276 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16277 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16278 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16279 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16282 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16283 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16284 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16288 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16289 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16290 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16292 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16293 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16294 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16295 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16296 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16297 cause the router to defer.
16299 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16300 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16302 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16304 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16305 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16307 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16308 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16309 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16310 of these values that is set:
16313 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16315 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16317 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16319 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16322 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16323 router, but not for the transport.
16327 .option self routers string freeze
16328 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16329 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16330 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16331 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16332 and &(manualroute)& routers.
16333 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16335 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16336 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16337 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16338 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16339 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16341 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16342 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16343 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16344 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16345 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16350 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16352 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16353 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16354 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16355 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16357 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16358 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16359 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16364 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16365 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16366 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16367 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16368 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16369 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16375 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16376 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16377 be passed to the next router.
16380 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16383 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
16384 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16385 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16386 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16387 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16388 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16393 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16394 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
16395 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16396 address matches something on the list.
16397 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16400 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16401 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16402 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16403 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16404 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16405 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16406 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16410 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16411 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
16412 .cindex "packet radio"
16413 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
16414 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
16415 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
16416 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
16417 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
16418 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
16419 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
16420 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
16422 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16423 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
16424 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
16425 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
16426 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
16427 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
16428 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
16429 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
16430 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
16431 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
16433 translate_ip_address = \
16434 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
16437 The file would contain lines like
16439 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
16440 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
16442 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
16447 .option transport routers string&!! unset
16448 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
16449 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
16450 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
16451 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
16452 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
16453 delivery is deferred.
16455 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
16456 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
16457 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
16461 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
16462 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
16463 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
16464 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
16465 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
16466 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
16467 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
16468 overridden by a setting on the transport.
16469 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16470 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16471 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
16477 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
16478 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
16479 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
16480 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
16481 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
16482 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
16483 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
16484 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
16485 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16486 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16488 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
16489 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
16490 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
16491 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
16492 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
16494 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
16500 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
16501 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
16502 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16503 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16504 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16505 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
16506 delivery to be deferred.
16508 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
16509 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
16510 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
16511 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
16512 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
16513 sometimes true and sometimes false).
16515 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
16516 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
16517 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
16518 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
16519 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
16520 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
16521 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
16522 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
16524 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
16525 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
16526 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
16527 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
16528 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
16529 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
16530 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
16531 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
16532 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
16533 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16535 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
16536 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
16537 subsequent routers.
16540 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
16541 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
16542 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16543 .cindex "transport" "local"
16544 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
16545 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
16546 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16547 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
16548 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16549 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16550 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
16551 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
16552 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
16553 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
16554 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
16555 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16559 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
16560 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
16561 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16564 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
16565 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
16567 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
16568 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
16569 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
16570 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
16571 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
16572 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
16574 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
16575 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
16576 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
16580 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
16581 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
16583 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
16584 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16588 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
16589 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
16590 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
16591 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16593 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
16594 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
16601 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16602 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16604 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
16605 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
16606 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
16607 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
16608 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
16609 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
16610 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
16611 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
16612 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
16616 domains = mydomain.example
16618 transport = local_delivery
16620 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
16621 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
16622 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
16623 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
16630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16631 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16633 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
16634 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
16635 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
16636 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
16637 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
16638 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
16640 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
16641 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
16642 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
16643 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
16646 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
16647 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
16648 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
16649 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
16650 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16651 generic option, the router declines.
16653 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
16654 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
16655 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
16657 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16658 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16659 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
16660 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
16661 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
16662 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
16665 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
16666 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
16667 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
16668 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
16669 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
16670 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
16672 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
16673 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
16674 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
16675 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
16676 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
16677 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
16678 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
16679 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
16680 case routing fails.
16685 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
16686 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
16687 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
16689 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
16690 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
16691 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
16692 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
16693 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
16694 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
16695 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16698 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
16699 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
16700 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
16701 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
16702 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
16703 required. For example,
16707 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
16708 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
16709 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
16710 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
16711 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
16714 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
16715 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
16716 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
16717 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
16718 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
16719 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
16721 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
16722 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
16723 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
16724 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
16725 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
16726 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
16727 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
16728 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
16730 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
16731 when there is a DNS lookup error.
16735 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16736 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
16737 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
16738 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
16739 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
16740 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
16741 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
16744 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
16746 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
16747 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
16748 the address record.
16751 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16752 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16753 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
16754 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16759 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
16760 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16761 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
16762 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
16763 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
16764 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
16765 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
16766 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
16767 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
16772 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
16773 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
16774 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
16775 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
16776 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
16777 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
16778 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
16779 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
16780 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
16781 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
16782 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
16784 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
16785 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
16788 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
16789 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
16790 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
16791 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
16792 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
16796 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
16797 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
16798 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
16799 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
16800 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
16801 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
16802 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
16803 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
16805 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
16806 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
16807 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
16808 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
16809 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
16810 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
16811 without processing them independently,
16812 provided the following conditions are met:
16815 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
16816 &%headers_remove%&.
16818 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
16825 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
16826 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16827 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
16828 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
16829 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
16830 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
16831 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
16832 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
16833 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
16834 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
16836 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
16837 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
16842 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16843 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16844 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
16845 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16850 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
16851 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
16852 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
16853 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
16856 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
16858 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
16859 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
16860 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
16861 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
16862 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
16863 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
16866 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
16867 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
16868 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
16869 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
16870 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
16872 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
16873 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
16874 such as that implied by
16878 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
16879 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
16880 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
16881 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
16891 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16892 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16894 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
16895 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
16896 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
16897 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
16898 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
16899 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
16900 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
16901 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
16902 router handles the address
16906 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
16907 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
16908 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
16910 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
16912 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
16913 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
16915 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
16916 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
16917 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
16918 &%self%& option determines what happens.
16920 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
16921 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
16922 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
16923 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
16927 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16928 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16930 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
16931 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
16932 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
16933 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
16934 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
16935 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
16938 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
16940 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
16942 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
16943 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
16944 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
16945 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
16946 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
16947 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
16948 must not be specified for it.
16950 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
16951 .option hosts iplookup string unset
16952 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
16953 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
16954 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
16955 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
16956 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
16959 .option optional iplookup boolean false
16960 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
16961 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
16962 delivery to the address is deferred.
16965 .option port iplookup integer 0
16966 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
16967 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
16971 .option protocol iplookup string udp
16972 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
16973 protocols is to be used.
16976 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
16977 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
16980 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
16982 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
16983 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
16986 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
16987 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
16988 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
16989 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
16990 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
16991 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
16992 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
16993 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
16996 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
16997 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
16998 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
16999 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
17000 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
17001 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
17002 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17003 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17004 following could be used:
17006 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17007 reroute = $local_part@$1
17010 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
17011 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17012 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17013 call. It does not apply to UDP.
17018 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17019 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17021 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17022 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17023 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17024 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17025 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17026 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17027 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17028 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17029 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17030 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17032 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17033 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17034 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17035 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17036 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17037 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17038 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17041 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17042 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17043 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17044 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17045 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17046 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17047 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17050 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17051 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17052 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17053 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17054 below, following the list of private options.
17057 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17059 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17060 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17062 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17063 See &%host_find_failed%&.
17065 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17066 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17067 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17068 of the following values:
17077 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17078 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17079 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17082 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17083 router only if &%more%& is true.
17085 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17086 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17087 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17088 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17090 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17091 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
17092 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
17095 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
17096 .cindex "randomized host list"
17097 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
17098 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
17099 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
17100 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
17101 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
17102 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
17103 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
17104 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17106 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17107 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17108 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17109 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17111 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17113 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17114 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17115 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17116 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17117 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17120 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17121 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17122 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17125 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17127 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17128 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17132 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17133 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17134 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17135 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17138 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17139 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17140 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17141 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17142 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17143 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17144 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17145 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17147 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17148 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17149 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17150 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17151 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17152 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17153 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17154 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17159 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17160 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17161 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17162 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17163 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17164 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17166 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17168 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17172 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17173 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17175 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17176 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17177 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17178 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17179 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17180 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17181 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17182 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17183 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17184 in a &%route_list%&).
17186 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17187 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17188 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17189 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17193 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17194 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17195 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17196 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17197 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17198 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17199 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17202 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17203 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17205 This data can be accessed by setting
17207 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17209 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17210 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17211 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17212 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17213 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17218 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17219 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17220 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17221 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17222 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17223 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17224 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17226 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17227 variables are set during its expansion:
17230 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17231 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17232 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17234 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17237 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17239 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17242 .vindex "&$value$&"
17243 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17244 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17246 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17250 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17251 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17255 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17256 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17257 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17258 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17259 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17260 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17263 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17264 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17265 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17267 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17268 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17271 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17272 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17273 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17274 number follows. For example:
17276 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17280 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17281 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17282 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17283 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17284 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17287 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17288 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17289 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17290 records in the DNS. For example:
17292 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17294 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17297 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17299 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17300 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17301 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17302 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17303 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17304 happens is controlled by the
17305 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17306 &%self%& option of the router.
17308 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17309 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17310 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17311 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17312 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17313 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17314 defined by MX preferences.
17316 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17317 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17318 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17320 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17321 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17322 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17323 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17325 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17326 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17329 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17330 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17331 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17333 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17334 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17338 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17339 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17340 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17341 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17342 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17343 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17344 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17347 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17348 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17350 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17351 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17353 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17354 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17355 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17357 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17358 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17359 timeout), delivery is deferred.
17364 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17365 domain2 host4:host5
17367 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17368 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17369 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17370 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17373 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17374 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17375 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17376 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
17381 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
17382 &%host_find_failed%& option.
17385 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
17386 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
17390 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
17391 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
17392 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
17395 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
17396 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
17397 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
17398 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
17400 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
17402 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
17403 your first router something like this:
17406 driver = manualroute
17407 domains = !+local_domains
17408 transport = remote_smtp
17409 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
17411 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
17412 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
17413 they are tried in order
17414 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
17415 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
17418 driver = manualroute
17419 transport = remote_smtp
17420 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
17422 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
17423 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
17424 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
17425 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
17426 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
17427 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
17428 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
17429 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
17432 .cindex "mail hub example"
17433 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
17434 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
17435 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
17436 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
17437 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
17438 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
17439 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
17440 lookup is easier to manage.
17442 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
17443 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
17447 driver = manualroute
17448 transport = remote_smtp
17449 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
17451 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
17452 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
17453 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
17454 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
17455 domain can be used to find the host:
17458 driver = manualroute
17459 transport = remote_smtp
17460 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
17462 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
17463 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
17464 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
17468 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
17469 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
17470 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
17471 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
17472 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
17473 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
17476 driver = manualroute
17477 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
17478 route_list = saved.domain.example
17480 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
17481 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
17482 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
17485 driver = manualroute
17487 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
17488 *.saved.domain2.example \
17489 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
17492 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17494 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
17495 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
17496 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
17497 the address if the lookup fails.
17500 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
17501 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
17502 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
17503 one way it can be done:
17509 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
17510 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
17511 return_fail_output = true
17516 driver = manualroute
17518 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
17520 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
17522 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
17524 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
17525 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
17526 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
17528 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
17529 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
17538 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17539 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17541 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
17542 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
17543 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
17544 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
17545 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
17546 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
17547 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
17548 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
17549 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
17550 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
17552 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
17554 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
17555 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
17556 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
17557 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
17558 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
17561 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
17562 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
17563 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
17564 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
17565 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
17566 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
17569 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
17570 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
17571 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
17572 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
17573 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
17574 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
17575 not set, a value for the gid also.
17577 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
17578 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
17579 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
17580 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
17581 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
17582 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
17586 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
17587 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
17588 before running the command.
17591 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
17592 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
17593 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
17597 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
17598 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
17599 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
17600 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
17601 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
17604 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
17607 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
17608 &%no_more%& is set.
17610 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
17611 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
17612 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
17613 included in the SMTP response.
17615 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
17616 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
17617 included in any SMTP response.
17619 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
17621 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
17622 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
17624 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
17625 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
17626 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
17629 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
17630 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
17633 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
17634 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
17636 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
17637 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
17638 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
17639 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
17641 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
17642 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
17643 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
17644 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
17645 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
17647 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
17648 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
17649 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
17650 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
17651 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
17653 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17654 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
17655 variable. For example, this return line
17657 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
17659 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
17660 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
17661 .ecindex IIDquerou1
17662 .ecindex IIDquerou2
17667 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17668 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17670 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
17671 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
17672 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
17673 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
17674 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
17675 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
17676 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
17677 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
17678 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
17679 redirected in several different ways:
17682 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
17685 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
17687 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
17689 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
17691 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
17693 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
17695 It can be discarded.
17698 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
17699 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
17700 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
17701 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
17705 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
17706 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
17707 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
17708 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
17709 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
17710 aliases, in a configuration like this:
17714 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
17716 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
17717 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
17718 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
17719 cause delivery to be deferred.
17721 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
17722 &_.forward_& files, like this:
17727 file = $home/.forward
17730 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
17731 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
17732 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
17733 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
17738 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
17739 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
17740 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
17741 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
17744 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
17745 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
17746 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
17747 practice the router may not be able to operate.
17749 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
17750 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
17751 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
17752 saves some resources.
17760 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
17761 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17762 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17763 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
17764 can be interpreted in two different ways:
17767 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
17768 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
17769 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
17770 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
17771 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
17772 document is intended for use by end users.
17774 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
17775 described in the next section.
17778 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
17779 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
17780 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
17781 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
17782 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
17786 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
17787 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
17788 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
17789 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
17790 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
17791 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
17792 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
17793 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
17794 commas or newlines.
17795 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
17798 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
17799 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
17800 next newline character is ignored.
17802 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
17803 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
17804 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
17805 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
17808 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17809 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
17810 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
17811 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
17812 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
17813 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
17816 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
17820 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
17821 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
17822 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
17823 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
17824 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
17825 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
17826 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
17827 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
17828 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
17829 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
17830 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
17832 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
17833 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
17834 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
17835 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
17836 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
17838 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
17840 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
17841 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
17842 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
17843 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
17844 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
17847 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
17848 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
17849 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
17850 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
17851 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
17853 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
17854 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
17859 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
17860 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
17863 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17865 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
17866 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
17867 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
17868 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
17869 should really contain
17871 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17873 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
17874 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
17875 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
17879 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
17880 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
17881 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
17884 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
17885 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
17886 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
17887 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
17888 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
17889 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17890 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17892 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
17893 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
17894 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
17895 in double quotes, for example:
17897 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
17899 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
17900 quote just the command. An item such as
17902 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
17904 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
17907 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
17908 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
17909 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
17910 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
17912 /home/world/minbari
17914 is treated as a file name, but
17916 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
17918 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
17919 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
17920 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
17921 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
17923 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17924 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17926 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
17927 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
17928 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
17929 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
17932 .cindex "included address list"
17933 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
17934 If an item is of the form
17936 :include:<path name>
17938 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
17939 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
17940 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
17941 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
17942 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
17943 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
17945 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
17947 It must be given as
17949 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
17952 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
17953 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
17954 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
17955 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
17956 .cindex "black hole"
17957 .cindex "abandoning mail"
17958 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
17959 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
17960 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
17962 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
17963 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
17964 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
17965 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
17969 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
17970 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
17971 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
17972 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
17973 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
17974 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
17975 redirection items of the form
17980 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
17981 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
17982 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
17983 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
17985 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
17987 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
17989 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
17990 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
17992 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
17993 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
17994 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
17996 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
17997 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
17998 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
17999 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
18000 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
18001 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
18002 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18003 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18004 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18007 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18008 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18009 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18010 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18012 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18013 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18014 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18015 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18016 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18018 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18019 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18020 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18021 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18022 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18026 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18027 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18028 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18029 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18030 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18031 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18032 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18036 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18037 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18038 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18039 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18040 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18041 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18042 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18043 aliasing scheme of the type
18045 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18049 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18050 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18051 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18054 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18055 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18057 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18058 the pipes are distinct.
18062 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18063 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18064 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18065 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18066 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18067 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18068 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18069 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18070 can be used to avoid this.
18073 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18074 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18075 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18076 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18077 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18078 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18079 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
18083 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
18085 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
18086 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
18089 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
18090 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
18091 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
18094 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
18095 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
18096 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
18097 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
18100 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
18101 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
18102 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18103 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18104 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18105 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18106 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18108 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18109 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18112 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18113 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18114 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18115 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18116 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18120 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18121 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18122 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18123 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18124 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18125 let ordinary users do.
18129 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18130 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18131 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18132 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18133 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18134 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18136 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18137 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18138 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18139 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18140 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18141 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18143 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18145 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18146 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18147 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18148 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18149 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18150 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18151 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18152 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18155 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18156 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18157 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18158 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18159 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18160 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18161 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18162 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18166 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18167 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18168 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18169 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18170 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18171 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18174 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18175 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18176 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18177 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18178 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18179 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18181 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18182 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18183 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18185 data = #Exim filter\n\
18186 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18188 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18189 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18190 choice into a newline.
18193 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18194 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18195 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18196 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18197 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18200 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18201 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18202 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18203 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18204 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18205 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18206 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18207 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18209 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18210 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18211 runs a check on the containing directory,
18212 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18213 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18214 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18215 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18216 not, the router declines.
18219 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18220 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18221 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18222 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18223 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18224 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18225 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18228 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18229 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18230 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18231 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18232 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18235 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18236 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18240 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18241 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18242 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18247 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18248 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18249 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18250 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18251 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18252 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18253 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18254 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18255 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18258 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18259 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18260 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18261 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18264 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18265 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18266 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18267 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18269 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18270 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18271 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18272 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18273 &_.forward_& files).
18276 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18277 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18278 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18281 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18282 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18283 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18284 of the embedded Perl support.
18287 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18288 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18289 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18292 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18293 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18294 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18297 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18298 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18299 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18300 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18301 &%one_time%& is set.
18304 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18305 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18306 to make use of &%run%& items.
18309 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18310 If this option is true, items of the form
18312 :include:<path name>
18314 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18317 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18318 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18319 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18320 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18321 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18324 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18325 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18326 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18329 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18330 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18331 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18332 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18333 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18338 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18339 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18340 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18341 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18342 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18343 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18344 bounce may well quote the generated address.
18347 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18349 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18350 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18351 file did not exist.
18354 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18356 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18357 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18358 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18360 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18361 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18362 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18363 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18364 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18365 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18366 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18367 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
18371 .option include_directory redirect string unset
18372 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
18373 redirection list must start with this directory.
18376 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
18377 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
18378 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
18381 .option one_time redirect boolean false
18382 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
18383 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
18384 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
18385 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
18386 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
18387 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
18388 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
18389 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
18390 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
18391 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
18392 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
18393 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
18394 before they subscribed.
18396 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18397 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18398 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18399 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
18402 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
18403 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
18404 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
18405 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
18407 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18408 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
18409 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
18411 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
18414 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18415 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18416 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18417 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
18418 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18422 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
18423 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
18424 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
18425 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
18426 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
18427 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
18428 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
18429 See &%check_owner%& above.
18432 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
18433 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
18434 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
18435 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
18438 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
18439 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18440 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
18441 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
18442 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
18443 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
18444 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
18447 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
18448 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
18449 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
18450 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
18451 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
18452 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
18453 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
18454 &$qualify_recipient$&.
18456 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
18457 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
18458 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
18461 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
18462 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
18463 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
18464 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
18465 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
18466 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
18467 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
18468 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
18469 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
18470 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
18473 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
18474 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
18475 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
18476 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
18477 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
18478 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
18481 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
18482 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
18483 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
18484 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
18485 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
18486 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
18489 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
18490 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
18491 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
18492 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
18493 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
18496 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
18497 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
18498 :subaddress part of an address.
18500 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
18501 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
18502 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
18503 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
18506 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
18507 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
18508 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
18509 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
18510 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
18511 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
18512 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
18516 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
18517 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
18518 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
18519 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
18520 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
18521 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
18522 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
18523 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
18524 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
18525 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
18526 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
18527 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
18528 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
18529 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
18530 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
18531 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
18533 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
18534 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
18535 the following routers.
18537 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
18538 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
18539 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
18540 so it is passed to the following routers.
18542 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
18543 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
18544 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
18545 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
18547 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
18548 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
18549 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
18550 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
18556 file = $home/.forward
18557 file_transport = address_file
18558 pipe_transport = address_pipe
18559 reply_transport = address_reply
18562 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
18563 syntax_errors_text = \
18564 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
18565 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
18566 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
18567 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
18568 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
18569 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
18570 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
18571 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
18572 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
18573 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
18575 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
18576 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
18577 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
18582 local_part_prefix = real-
18583 transport = local_delivery
18585 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18586 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18588 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18589 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18593 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
18594 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18597 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
18598 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18599 .ecindex IIDredrou1
18600 .ecindex IIDredrou2
18607 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18608 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18610 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
18611 "Environment for local transports"
18612 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
18613 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
18614 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
18615 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
18616 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
18617 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
18618 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
18620 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
18621 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
18622 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
18623 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
18625 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
18626 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
18627 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
18628 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
18629 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
18633 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
18634 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
18635 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
18636 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
18637 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
18638 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
18639 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
18642 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
18643 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
18647 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
18649 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
18650 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
18651 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
18652 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
18657 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
18658 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18659 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
18660 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
18661 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
18662 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
18663 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
18664 group (set by the transport). For example:
18667 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
18671 transport = group_delivery
18674 # This transport overrides the group
18676 driver = appendfile
18677 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
18680 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
18681 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
18682 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
18685 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
18686 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
18687 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
18688 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
18689 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
18690 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
18692 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
18693 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
18694 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
18695 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
18696 original gid is also used.
18698 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
18699 following that is set is used:
18702 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
18704 A &%group%& setting of the router;
18706 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
18707 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
18709 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
18711 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
18712 the uid is the creator's uid;
18714 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
18717 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
18718 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
18719 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
18720 The first of the following that is set is used:
18723 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
18725 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
18727 A &%user%& setting of the router;
18729 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
18734 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
18735 &%never_users%& list.
18741 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
18742 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18743 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18744 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
18745 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
18746 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
18747 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
18748 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
18749 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
18750 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18753 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18755 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18757 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18759 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18762 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18765 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
18767 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
18771 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
18772 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
18773 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
18777 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
18778 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18779 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18780 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
18781 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
18782 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
18783 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
18784 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
18785 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
18786 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
18787 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
18788 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
18789 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
18790 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
18798 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18799 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18801 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
18802 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
18803 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
18804 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
18805 The following generic options apply to all transports:
18808 .option body_only transports boolean false
18809 .cindex "transport" "body only"
18810 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
18811 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
18812 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
18813 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
18814 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
18815 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
18816 automatically suppress them.
18819 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
18820 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
18821 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
18822 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
18823 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18824 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18827 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
18828 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
18829 deliveries by the transport or for any
18830 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
18831 what you are doing.
18834 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
18835 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18836 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18837 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
18839 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18840 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18841 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18842 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
18843 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
18844 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
18848 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
18849 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
18850 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
18851 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
18852 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
18853 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
18854 safely be resent to other recipients.
18857 .option driver transports string unset
18858 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
18859 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
18862 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
18863 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
18864 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
18865 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
18866 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
18867 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
18868 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
18869 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
18870 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
18871 resent to other recipients.
18874 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
18875 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
18876 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
18877 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
18878 &%user%& (see below).
18881 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
18882 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
18883 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
18884 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
18885 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
18886 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
18887 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18888 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18889 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18893 .option headers_only transports boolean false
18894 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
18895 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
18896 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
18897 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
18898 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
18899 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
18900 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
18903 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
18904 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18905 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
18906 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
18907 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
18908 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
18909 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18910 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18911 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18915 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
18916 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
18917 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
18918 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
18919 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
18920 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
18921 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
18922 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
18925 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
18928 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
18929 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
18930 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
18931 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
18932 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
18933 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
18934 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
18935 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
18936 change envelope recipients at this time.
18939 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
18940 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
18942 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
18943 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
18944 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
18945 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
18946 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
18947 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
18948 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
18952 .option initgroups transports boolean false
18953 .cindex "additional groups"
18954 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18955 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
18956 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
18957 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
18958 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
18961 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
18962 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
18963 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
18964 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
18965 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
18966 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
18967 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
18968 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
18969 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
18970 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
18971 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
18972 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
18973 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
18978 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
18979 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
18980 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
18981 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
18982 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
18983 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
18984 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
18985 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
18988 local_part_prefix = *-
18990 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
18993 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
18995 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
18996 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
18997 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
18998 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
18999 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
19002 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19003 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19004 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19005 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19006 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19007 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19008 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19009 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19010 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19012 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19013 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19014 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19015 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19017 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19018 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19019 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19022 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
19023 .cindex "envelope sender"
19024 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19025 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19026 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19027 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19028 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19029 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19030 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19031 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19032 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19034 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19035 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19037 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
19038 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19039 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19040 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19041 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19042 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19043 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19045 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19046 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19047 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19048 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19049 &%errors_to%& in a router.
19053 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
19054 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19055 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19056 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19057 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19058 have easy access to it.
19060 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19061 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19062 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19063 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19064 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19068 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19069 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
19072 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
19073 .cindex "shadow transport"
19074 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
19075 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
19076 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
19078 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
19079 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
19080 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
19081 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
19082 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
19083 cause a log line to be written.
19085 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
19086 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
19087 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
19088 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
19089 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
19092 ST=<shadow transport name>
19094 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
19095 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
19096 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
19097 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
19098 headers that some sites insist on.
19101 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
19102 .cindex "transport" "filter"
19103 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19104 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19105 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19106 individual users or via a system filter.
19108 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19109 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19110 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19111 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19112 command must be specified as an absolute path.
19114 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
19115 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
19116 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
19117 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
19118 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
19119 &(pipe)& transports.
19121 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19122 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19123 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19124 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19125 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19127 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19128 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
19129 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
19130 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19132 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19133 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19134 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19135 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19136 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19137 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19139 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19140 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19141 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19142 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19143 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19144 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19145 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19146 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19148 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19149 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19150 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19151 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19152 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19153 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19154 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19155 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19156 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19157 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19160 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19161 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19162 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19163 which the message is being sent. For example:
19165 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19166 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19169 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19170 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19171 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19173 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19174 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19175 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19178 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19180 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19181 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19182 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19183 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19184 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19185 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19187 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19188 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19189 arguments. Consider this example:
19191 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19192 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19194 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19195 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19197 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19198 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19202 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19203 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19204 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19205 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19206 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19207 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19208 bounced from a transport filter.
19210 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19211 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19212 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19215 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19216 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19217 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19218 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19219 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19220 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19221 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19222 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19223 becomes a temporary error.
19226 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19227 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19228 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19229 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19230 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19231 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19232 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19235 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19236 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19237 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19239 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19240 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19241 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19242 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19244 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19245 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19246 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19253 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19254 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19256 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19258 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19259 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19260 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19261 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19262 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19263 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19264 copy of the message is delivered each time.
19266 .cindex "batched local delivery"
19267 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19268 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19269 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19270 local transport, for example:
19273 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19274 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19275 recipients saves space.
19277 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19278 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19280 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19281 to a scanner program or
19282 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19286 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19287 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19288 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19290 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19291 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19292 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19293 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19294 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19295 to certain conditions:
19298 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19299 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19300 batching is possible.
19302 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19303 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19304 addresses with the same domain are batched.
19306 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19307 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19308 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19309 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19310 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19313 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19314 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19315 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19319 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19320 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19321 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19322 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19323 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19324 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19325 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19328 escape_string = ".."
19330 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19331 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19332 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19334 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19335 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19336 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19337 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19338 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19339 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19341 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19342 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19343 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19344 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19345 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19346 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19347 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19348 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19349 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19354 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19355 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19357 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19358 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19359 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19360 .cindex "directory creation"
19361 .cindex "creating directories"
19362 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19363 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19364 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19365 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19366 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19367 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
19368 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
19369 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
19370 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19371 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
19373 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19374 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19375 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
19378 .cindex "quota" "system"
19379 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19380 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19381 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19383 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19384 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19385 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19386 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19388 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19389 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19392 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
19393 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
19394 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
19395 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
19400 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
19401 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19402 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19403 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19404 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
19406 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19407 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19408 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
19409 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19410 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
19411 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
19412 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
19413 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19414 operation. There are two cases:
19417 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
19418 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
19419 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19420 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
19421 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19422 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19423 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
19425 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
19426 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19427 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
19431 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
19432 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
19433 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
19434 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
19439 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
19441 require "fileinto";
19442 fileinto "folder23";
19444 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
19445 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
19446 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
19447 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
19448 way of handling this requirement:
19450 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
19451 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
19452 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
19454 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
19458 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
19459 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
19460 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
19462 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
19463 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
19464 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
19465 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
19466 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
19467 path to the transport.
19469 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
19470 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
19475 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
19476 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
19480 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
19481 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
19482 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
19483 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
19484 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
19485 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
19486 delivery is deferred.
19489 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
19490 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
19491 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
19492 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
19493 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
19494 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
19495 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
19496 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
19499 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
19500 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19501 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
19502 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
19506 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
19507 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19510 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
19511 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
19512 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
19513 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
19514 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
19517 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
19518 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
19519 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
19520 process is running.
19523 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
19524 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19525 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
19526 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
19527 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
19528 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
19529 contains is significant.
19531 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
19532 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
19533 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
19534 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
19535 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
19537 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
19538 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
19539 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
19540 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
19541 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
19542 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
19544 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19545 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
19546 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19547 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19549 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
19550 .cindex "directory creation"
19551 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
19552 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
19553 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
19555 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
19556 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
19557 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
19558 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
19559 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
19563 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
19564 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
19565 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
19566 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
19567 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
19570 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
19571 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
19572 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
19573 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
19574 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
19575 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
19576 &%file_must_exist%&.
19579 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
19580 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
19581 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
19582 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
19584 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
19585 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
19586 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
19587 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
19588 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
19591 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
19593 .vindex "&$inode$&"
19594 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
19595 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
19596 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
19598 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
19600 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
19601 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
19605 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
19606 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
19607 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
19610 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
19611 See &%check_string%& above.
19614 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
19615 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
19616 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
19617 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
19618 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
19619 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
19622 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
19623 .cindex "locking files"
19624 .cindex "lock files"
19625 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
19626 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
19628 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
19629 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
19632 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19633 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
19636 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
19637 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
19638 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
19639 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
19640 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
19641 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
19645 .option file_format appendfile string unset
19646 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
19647 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
19648 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
19649 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
19650 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
19651 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
19652 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
19653 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
19656 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
19657 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
19659 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
19660 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
19661 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
19662 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
19663 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
19664 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
19665 delivery is deferred.
19668 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
19669 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
19670 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
19671 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
19674 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
19675 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19676 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
19677 .cindex "locking files"
19678 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
19679 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
19680 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
19681 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
19682 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
19683 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
19684 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
19685 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
19687 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
19688 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
19689 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
19690 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
19692 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
19693 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
19696 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
19698 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
19699 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
19700 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
19702 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
19703 local deliveries because of errors of the form
19705 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
19708 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
19709 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
19710 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
19711 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
19714 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
19715 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
19716 for details of locking.
19719 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
19720 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
19721 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
19724 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19725 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
19726 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
19729 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
19730 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19731 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
19732 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
19733 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
19736 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
19737 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19738 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19739 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19740 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
19741 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
19742 external source that maintains the data.
19745 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
19746 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19747 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19748 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19749 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
19750 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
19751 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
19752 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
19756 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
19757 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
19758 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
19759 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
19760 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
19761 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
19762 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
19763 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
19764 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
19765 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19768 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
19769 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
19770 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
19771 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
19772 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
19773 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
19774 calculation. The default value is:
19776 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
19778 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
19779 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
19781 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
19783 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
19785 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
19786 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
19787 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
19788 directly into that directory.
19791 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
19792 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
19793 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19796 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
19797 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
19798 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19801 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile boolean false
19802 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
19803 Setting this option true enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
19804 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
19805 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
19806 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
19807 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19809 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
19810 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
19811 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
19812 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
19813 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
19814 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
19815 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
19816 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
19817 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
19818 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
19821 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
19822 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
19823 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
19824 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
19825 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
19826 below for further details.
19829 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
19830 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19831 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19834 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
19835 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19836 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19839 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
19840 .cindex "locking files"
19841 .cindex "file" "locking"
19842 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
19843 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
19844 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
19845 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
19846 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
19847 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
19848 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
19850 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
19851 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
19852 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
19859 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
19860 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
19861 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
19862 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
19863 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
19864 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
19865 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
19866 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
19868 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
19869 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
19870 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
19871 append messages to it.
19874 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19875 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19876 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
19877 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19878 in which case it is:
19880 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
19881 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
19883 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19884 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
19886 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19887 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
19888 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19889 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
19894 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19895 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
19897 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19898 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
19899 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
19900 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
19901 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
19902 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
19903 value, and this option is ignored.
19906 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
19907 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
19908 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
19909 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
19910 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
19913 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
19914 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
19915 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
19916 on users about incoming mail.
19919 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
19920 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
19921 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
19922 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
19923 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
19924 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
19925 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
19926 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
19927 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
19929 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
19930 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
19931 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
19933 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
19934 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
19935 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
19936 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
19937 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
19938 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
19940 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
19941 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
19942 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
19943 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
19946 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
19948 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
19949 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
19950 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
19951 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
19952 system quota failures.
19954 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
19955 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
19956 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
19957 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
19958 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
19959 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
19960 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
19961 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
19962 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
19963 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
19966 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
19967 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
19968 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
19969 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
19970 delivery directory.
19973 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
19974 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
19975 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
19976 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
19977 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
19981 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
19982 See &%quota%& above.
19985 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
19986 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
19987 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
19988 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
19989 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
19990 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
19991 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
19993 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
19994 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
19995 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
19996 the file length to the file name. For example:
19998 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
19999 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
20001 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
20002 number of lines in the message.
20004 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20005 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20006 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20010 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20011 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20012 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20014 quota_warn_message = "\
20015 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20016 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20017 This message is automatically created \
20018 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20019 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20020 a warning threshold that is\n\
20021 set by the system administrator.\n"
20025 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20026 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20027 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20028 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20029 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20030 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20031 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20032 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20033 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20037 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20039 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20040 percent sign is ignored.
20042 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20043 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20044 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20045 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20046 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20047 &'From:'& line, the default is:
20049 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20051 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20052 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20055 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20056 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20060 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20061 .cindex "envelope sender"
20062 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20063 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20064 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20065 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20066 for details of batch SMTP.
20069 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
20070 .cindex "carriage return"
20072 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
20073 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
20074 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
20075 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
20077 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
20078 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
20079 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
20080 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
20081 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
20082 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
20085 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20086 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
20087 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
20088 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
20089 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20090 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
20093 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
20094 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
20095 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
20096 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
20097 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
20099 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
20100 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20101 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20102 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20104 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20105 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20106 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20107 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20108 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20111 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
20112 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
20115 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
20116 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
20117 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20118 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20119 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20120 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20121 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20123 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20124 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20125 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20126 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20129 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20130 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20131 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20134 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20135 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20136 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20137 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20138 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20139 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20140 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20141 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20142 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20144 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20145 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20146 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20147 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20152 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20153 .cindex "appending to a file"
20154 .cindex "file" "appending"
20155 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20158 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20162 .cindex "directory creation"
20163 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20164 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20165 &%directory_mode%& option.
20168 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20169 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20173 .cindex "file" "locking"
20174 .cindex "locking files"
20175 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20176 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20177 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20180 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20181 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20182 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20184 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20186 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20187 Unlink the hitching post name.
20189 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20190 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20191 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20192 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20194 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20195 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20196 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20197 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20198 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20199 it before trying again.
20203 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20204 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20205 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20208 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20209 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20210 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20211 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20212 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20213 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20214 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20215 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20216 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20220 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20221 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20222 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20223 delivery is deferred.
20226 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20227 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20228 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20232 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20233 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20234 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20237 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20238 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20239 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20242 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20243 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20244 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20245 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20246 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20247 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20248 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20249 that prevents link following.
20252 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20253 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20254 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20255 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20256 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20259 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20262 .cindex "file" "locking"
20263 .cindex "locking files"
20264 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20265 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20266 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20267 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20268 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20270 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20272 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20273 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20274 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20276 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20277 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20278 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20280 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20281 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20282 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20283 delivery is deferred.
20285 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20286 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20287 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20288 immediately. It retries up to
20290 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20292 times (rounded up).
20295 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20296 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20299 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20300 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20301 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20302 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20303 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20304 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20305 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20306 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20307 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20308 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20310 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20311 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20312 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20313 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20314 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20315 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20316 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20318 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20319 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20320 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20321 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20324 .cindex "maildir format"
20325 .cindex "mailstore format"
20326 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20327 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20328 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20329 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20330 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20332 .cindex "directory creation"
20333 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20334 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20335 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20336 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20337 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20338 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20343 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20344 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20345 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20346 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20347 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20348 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20349 &_new_& subdirectory.
20351 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20352 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20353 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20354 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20355 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20356 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20357 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20359 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20360 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20361 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20362 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20363 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20364 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20365 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
20366 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
20368 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
20369 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
20370 folders. Consider this example:
20372 maildir_format = true
20373 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
20374 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
20375 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
20376 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
20378 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
20379 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
20380 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
20381 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
20382 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
20383 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
20385 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
20386 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
20387 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
20388 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
20389 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
20391 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
20392 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
20393 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
20395 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20396 .cindex "maildir++"
20397 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
20398 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
20399 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
20400 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20401 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20402 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20403 amount of space used.
20405 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20406 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20407 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20408 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20409 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20410 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20415 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
20416 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20417 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
20418 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20419 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20420 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20422 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
20423 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20424 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
20425 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
20426 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20427 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20428 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
20429 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20430 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
20435 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
20436 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20437 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20438 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
20439 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
20440 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
20441 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
20442 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
20443 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
20445 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
20446 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
20447 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
20448 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
20449 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
20450 need to know the quota.
20452 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
20453 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
20455 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
20456 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
20457 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
20461 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
20462 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
20463 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
20464 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
20465 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
20466 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
20467 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
20468 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
20470 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
20471 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
20472 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
20473 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
20474 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
20475 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
20477 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
20478 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
20479 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
20480 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
20481 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
20482 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
20484 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
20485 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
20486 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
20487 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
20490 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
20491 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
20492 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
20493 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
20494 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
20496 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
20498 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
20499 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
20500 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
20501 .ecindex IIDapptra1
20502 .ecindex IIDapptra2
20509 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20510 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20512 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
20513 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
20514 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
20515 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
20516 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
20517 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
20518 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
20519 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
20521 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
20522 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
20523 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
20524 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
20525 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
20528 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
20529 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
20530 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
20531 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
20532 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
20534 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
20535 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
20536 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
20537 transport is run as a consequence of a
20539 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
20540 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
20541 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
20542 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
20543 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
20544 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
20546 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
20547 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
20548 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
20549 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
20551 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
20552 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
20553 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
20554 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
20555 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
20556 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
20557 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
20559 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
20560 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
20561 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
20562 the transport defers.
20563 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
20564 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
20566 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
20567 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
20568 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
20569 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
20571 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
20572 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
20573 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
20574 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
20575 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
20576 problems. They are just discarded.
20580 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
20581 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
20583 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
20584 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
20585 message when the message is specified by the transport.
20588 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
20589 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
20590 when the message is specified by the transport.
20593 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
20594 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
20595 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
20596 string comes first.
20599 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
20600 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
20601 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
20604 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
20605 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
20606 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
20609 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
20610 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
20611 specified by the transport.
20614 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
20615 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
20616 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
20617 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
20620 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
20621 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
20622 the message is specified by the transport.
20625 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
20626 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
20630 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
20631 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
20632 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
20633 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
20634 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
20638 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
20639 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
20640 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
20641 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
20643 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
20644 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
20645 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
20646 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
20647 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
20648 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
20649 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
20652 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
20653 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
20654 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
20655 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
20656 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
20658 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
20659 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
20660 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
20661 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
20662 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
20663 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
20666 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
20667 See &%once%& above.
20670 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
20671 See &%once%& above.
20672 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
20675 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
20676 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
20677 specified by the transport.
20680 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
20681 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
20682 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
20683 configuration option.
20686 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
20687 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
20688 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
20689 automatic responses. For example:
20691 subject = Re: $h_subject:
20693 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
20694 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
20695 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
20696 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
20701 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
20702 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
20703 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
20704 the text comes first.
20707 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
20708 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
20709 when the message is specified by the transport.
20710 .ecindex IIDauttra1
20711 .ecindex IIDauttra2
20716 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20717 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20719 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
20720 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
20721 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
20722 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
20723 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
20724 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
20726 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
20727 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
20728 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
20729 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
20730 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
20731 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
20735 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
20736 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
20737 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
20740 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
20741 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20744 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
20745 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20746 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
20747 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
20748 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20751 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
20752 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
20753 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
20754 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
20755 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
20756 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
20759 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
20760 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
20761 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
20762 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
20763 in its response to the LHLO command.
20765 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
20766 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
20767 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
20768 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
20771 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
20772 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
20773 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
20774 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
20779 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
20783 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
20784 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
20788 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20789 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20791 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
20792 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
20793 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
20794 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
20795 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
20796 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
20797 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
20798 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
20802 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20803 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
20804 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
20805 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
20806 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
20808 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20809 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
20810 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
20811 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
20812 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
20813 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
20814 that are routed to the transport.
20816 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20817 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
20818 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
20819 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
20820 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
20821 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
20822 the local part that was redirected.
20826 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
20827 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
20828 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
20830 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
20831 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
20832 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
20833 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
20834 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
20835 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
20836 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
20839 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
20840 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
20841 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
20842 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
20843 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
20848 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
20849 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
20850 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
20851 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
20852 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
20853 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
20854 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
20855 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
20856 &"local delivery failed"&.
20858 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
20859 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
20860 value is the return code minus 128.
20862 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
20863 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
20864 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
20865 a non-existent command may be the problem.
20867 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
20868 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
20869 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
20870 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
20871 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
20872 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
20873 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
20878 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
20879 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
20880 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
20881 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
20882 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
20885 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
20886 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
20887 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
20888 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
20890 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
20891 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
20892 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
20893 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
20894 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
20896 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
20898 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
20899 arguments. You have to write
20901 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
20903 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
20904 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
20905 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
20906 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
20907 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
20908 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
20911 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
20914 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20915 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20916 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20917 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
20918 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
20919 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
20920 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
20921 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
20922 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
20923 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
20925 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
20926 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
20927 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
20928 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
20929 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
20930 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
20931 control what is done with it.
20933 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
20934 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
20935 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
20936 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
20937 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
20938 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
20939 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
20940 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
20941 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
20942 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
20943 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
20947 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
20948 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
20949 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
20950 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
20951 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
20952 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
20955 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
20956 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
20957 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
20958 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
20959 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
20960 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
20961 &`LOGNAME `& see below
20962 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
20963 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
20964 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
20965 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
20966 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
20967 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
20968 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
20969 &`USER `& see below
20971 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
20972 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
20973 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
20974 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
20975 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
20976 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
20977 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
20980 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
20981 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
20982 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
20986 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
20987 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
20988 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
20989 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
20992 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
20993 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
20997 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
20998 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
20999 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21000 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
21001 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
21002 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21003 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21004 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21005 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21006 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21007 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21010 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21012 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21013 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21014 &%use_shell%& is set.
21017 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21018 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21021 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
21022 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21023 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21026 .option check_string pipe string unset
21027 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21028 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21029 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21030 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21031 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21032 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21033 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21037 .option command pipe string&!! unset
21038 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21039 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
21040 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
21041 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
21042 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
21043 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
21046 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
21047 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21048 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
21049 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
21050 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
21051 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21052 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
21055 .option escape_string pipe string unset
21056 See &%check_string%& above.
21059 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
21060 .cindex "exec failure"
21061 .cindex "failure of exec"
21062 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
21063 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
21064 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
21065 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
21066 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
21069 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
21070 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
21071 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
21072 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
21073 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
21074 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
21076 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
21077 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
21079 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
21080 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
21081 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
21082 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
21083 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
21086 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
21087 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
21088 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
21089 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
21090 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
21091 Only one of them may be set.
21095 .option log_output pipe boolean false
21096 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
21097 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
21098 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21102 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
21103 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
21104 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
21105 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
21106 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
21107 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
21108 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
21109 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
21112 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
21113 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21114 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
21117 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21121 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
21122 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21123 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21124 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21125 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21130 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21131 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21134 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21135 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21136 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21137 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21141 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21142 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21145 .option path pipe string "see below"
21146 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21147 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21151 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21152 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21153 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21156 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
21157 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
21158 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
21159 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
21160 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
21161 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
21162 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
21163 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
21164 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
21167 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21168 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21169 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21170 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21171 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21172 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21173 accept the message is used.
21176 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21177 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21178 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21179 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21180 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21181 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21184 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21185 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21186 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21187 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21188 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21189 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21190 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21194 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21195 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21196 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21197 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21198 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21199 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21200 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21201 of them may be set.
21205 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21206 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21207 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21208 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21209 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21210 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21211 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21212 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21213 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21214 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21215 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21216 and 73, respectively.
21219 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21220 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21221 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21222 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21223 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21224 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21225 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21227 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21228 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21229 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21230 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21231 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21232 delivery to be deferred.
21234 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21235 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21238 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21239 .cindex "envelope sender"
21240 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21241 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21242 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21243 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21244 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21246 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21247 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21248 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21249 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21250 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21251 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21255 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21256 .cindex "carriage return"
21258 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21259 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21260 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21261 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21263 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21264 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21265 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21266 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21267 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21270 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
21271 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21272 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21273 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21274 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21275 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21276 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21277 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21278 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21283 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21284 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21285 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
21286 .cindex "external local delivery"
21287 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21288 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21289 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21290 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21291 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21292 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21293 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21294 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21295 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21296 configuration for &%procmail%&:
21301 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21305 check_string = "From "
21306 escape_string = ">From "
21315 transport = procmail_pipe
21317 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21318 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21319 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21320 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21321 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21322 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21324 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21328 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21329 use a shell to run pipe commands.
21332 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21333 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21336 local_delivery_cyrus:
21338 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21339 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21351 local_part_suffix = .*
21352 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21354 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
21355 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21357 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
21358 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
21361 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21362 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21364 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
21365 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
21366 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
21367 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21368 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21369 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21370 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21371 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
21374 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
21375 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21379 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
21380 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21381 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21382 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
21383 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
21384 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
21385 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
21387 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
21388 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21389 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21390 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21391 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21392 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21397 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21398 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
21399 no further messages are sent over that connection.
21403 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
21405 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21406 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
21407 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
21408 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
21409 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
21410 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
21411 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
21412 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
21415 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
21416 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
21417 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
21418 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_cipher$&
21419 and &$tls_peerdn$& are the values that were set when the message was received.
21420 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
21421 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these two
21422 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
21423 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
21424 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
21425 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
21428 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
21429 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
21430 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
21433 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
21434 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
21435 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
21436 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
21437 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
21438 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
21439 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
21440 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
21442 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
21443 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
21444 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21445 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
21446 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
21447 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
21448 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
21449 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
21450 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
21453 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
21455 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
21456 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
21457 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
21458 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
21459 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
21462 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
21463 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
21464 &$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
21465 particular connection.
21467 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
21468 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
21469 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
21470 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
21472 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
21473 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
21474 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
21476 authenticated_sender = $local_part
21478 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
21479 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
21481 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
21482 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
21486 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
21487 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
21488 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
21489 authenticated as a client.
21492 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
21493 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
21494 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
21495 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
21498 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
21499 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
21500 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
21501 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
21502 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
21503 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
21504 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
21507 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
21508 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
21509 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
21510 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21511 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
21512 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
21513 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
21517 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
21518 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
21519 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
21520 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
21523 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
21524 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
21525 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
21528 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
21529 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
21530 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
21531 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
21532 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
21533 unhappy at this prospect, so...
21535 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
21536 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
21537 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
21538 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
21539 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
21540 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
21541 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
21542 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
21546 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
21547 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
21548 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
21549 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
21550 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
21553 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
21554 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
21555 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
21556 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
21561 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
21562 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21563 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
21564 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
21565 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
21566 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21567 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21568 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
21570 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
21571 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
21572 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
21573 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
21574 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
21575 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
21577 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
21578 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
21579 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
21580 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
21581 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
21583 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
21584 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
21585 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
21586 copy of the message is sent.
21588 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
21589 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
21590 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
21591 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
21595 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
21596 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
21597 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
21600 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
21601 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
21602 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
21603 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
21604 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
21605 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
21607 .option gnutls_require_kx smtp string unset
21608 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21609 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21611 .option gnutls_require_mac smtp string unset
21612 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21613 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21615 .option gnutls_require_protocols smtp string unset
21616 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21617 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21619 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
21620 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
21621 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
21622 implementations of TLS.
21624 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
21625 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
21626 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
21627 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
21628 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
21629 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
21630 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
21635 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
21636 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
21637 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
21638 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
21639 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
21640 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
21641 interface address, you could use this:
21643 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
21644 {$primary_hostname}}
21646 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
21649 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
21650 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
21651 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
21652 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
21653 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
21654 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
21656 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
21657 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
21658 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
21659 &%hosts_override%& is set.
21661 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
21662 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
21663 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
21664 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21665 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21666 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
21667 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
21669 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
21670 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
21671 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
21672 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
21673 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
21674 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
21675 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
21678 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
21679 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
21682 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
21683 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
21684 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
21685 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
21686 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21687 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
21688 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
21689 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
21690 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
21691 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
21694 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
21695 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21696 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
21697 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
21700 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21701 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
21702 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21703 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21706 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
21707 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21708 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
21709 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
21710 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
21711 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
21712 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
21713 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
21716 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
21717 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
21718 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
21723 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21724 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
21725 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21726 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
21727 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
21728 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
21729 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
21730 explanation of when this might be needed.
21733 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
21734 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
21735 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
21736 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
21737 &%fallback_hosts%&.
21740 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
21741 .cindex "randomized host list"
21742 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
21743 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
21744 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
21745 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
21746 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
21747 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
21748 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
21749 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
21751 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
21752 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
21753 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
21754 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
21756 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
21758 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
21759 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
21760 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
21762 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21763 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
21764 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
21765 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
21766 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
21767 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
21768 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
21769 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
21770 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21773 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21774 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
21775 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21776 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21777 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
21778 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
21780 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21781 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
21782 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
21783 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
21784 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
21785 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
21786 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21788 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
21789 .cindex "bind IP address"
21790 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
21792 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21793 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
21794 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
21795 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
21796 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
21797 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
21798 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
21799 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
21802 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
21803 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
21804 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
21805 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
21806 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
21807 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
21809 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
21811 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
21812 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
21813 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
21814 interface to use if the host has more than one.
21817 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
21818 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
21819 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
21820 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
21821 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
21822 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
21823 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
21824 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
21825 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
21826 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
21830 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
21831 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21832 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
21833 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
21834 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
21836 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
21837 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
21838 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
21839 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
21840 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
21844 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
21845 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21846 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
21847 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
21848 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
21849 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
21850 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
21851 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
21854 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
21855 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
21856 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
21857 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
21858 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
21859 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
21860 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
21861 variable that contains an outgoing port.
21863 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
21864 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
21865 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
21866 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
21871 .option protocol smtp string smtp
21872 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
21873 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
21874 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
21875 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
21876 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
21877 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
21880 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
21881 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
21882 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
21883 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
21884 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
21885 addresses is not affected.
21887 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
21888 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
21889 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
21890 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
21891 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
21895 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
21896 .cindex "serializing connections"
21897 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
21898 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
21899 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
21900 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
21901 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
21902 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
21903 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
21905 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
21906 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
21907 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
21908 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
21909 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21910 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21912 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
21913 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21914 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21915 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21916 are used for ETRN serialization.
21919 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
21920 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21921 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
21922 .cindex "size" "of message"
21923 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21924 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21925 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
21926 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
21927 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
21928 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
21929 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
21930 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
21932 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
21933 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
21936 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
21937 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
21938 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
21940 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21941 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21942 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
21943 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
21944 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
21947 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
21948 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
21949 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
21950 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
21954 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
21955 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
21956 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
21957 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
21958 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
21961 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
21962 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
21964 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21965 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21966 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
21967 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
21968 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21969 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
21970 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
21971 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21974 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
21975 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
21976 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
21978 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21979 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
21980 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
21981 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
21982 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21983 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
21984 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
21985 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
21986 ciphers is a preference order.
21990 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
21991 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
21992 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
21993 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
21994 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
21995 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
21996 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
21997 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
21998 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
21999 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
22003 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
22004 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
22005 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
22007 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22008 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
22009 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
22010 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
22011 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
22012 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
22013 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
22014 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22015 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22020 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
22022 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22023 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
22024 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
22025 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
22026 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
22029 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
22030 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
22031 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
22032 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
22035 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
22036 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
22037 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
22039 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
22040 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
22041 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
22042 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
22043 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
22045 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
22046 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
22047 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
22048 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
22049 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
22050 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
22051 see below for an exception).
22053 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
22054 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
22055 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
22056 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
22057 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
22059 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
22060 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
22061 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
22062 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
22063 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
22064 reached their retry times.
22066 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
22067 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
22068 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
22069 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
22070 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
22071 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
22072 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
22073 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
22074 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
22075 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
22078 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
22079 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
22080 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
22081 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
22082 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
22083 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
22085 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
22086 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
22087 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
22088 possible IP addresses have been tried.
22089 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
22090 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
22096 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22097 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22099 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
22100 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
22101 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
22102 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
22103 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
22104 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
22106 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
22107 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
22108 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
22109 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
22110 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
22111 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
22112 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
22114 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
22115 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
22116 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
22117 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
22120 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
22121 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
22122 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
22123 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
22125 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
22126 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
22127 facility; you do not have to use it.
22129 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
22130 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
22131 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
22132 address to which it applies.
22134 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
22135 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22136 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22137 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22138 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22139 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22142 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22143 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22144 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22145 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22148 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22149 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22150 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22151 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22152 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22155 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22156 illustrated by these examples:
22159 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22160 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22161 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22162 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22164 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22165 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22170 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22171 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22172 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22173 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22174 message's processing.
22176 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22177 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22178 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22179 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22180 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22181 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22182 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22183 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22184 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22186 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22187 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22188 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22189 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22190 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22191 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22192 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22193 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22194 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22195 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22197 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22198 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22199 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22200 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22201 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22202 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22204 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22205 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22206 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22208 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22209 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22210 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22211 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22212 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22213 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22214 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22215 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22216 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22218 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22219 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22225 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22226 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22227 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22228 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22229 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22230 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
22231 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22232 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22233 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22234 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22236 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22238 might produce the output
22240 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22241 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22242 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22243 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22244 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22245 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22246 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22247 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22249 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22250 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22251 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22252 set for a particular transport.
22255 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22256 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22257 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22260 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22262 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22263 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22264 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22265 any colons must be doubled, of course).
22267 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22268 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22269 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22270 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22273 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22274 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22275 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22277 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22278 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22279 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22280 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22281 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22282 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22283 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22285 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22286 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22287 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
22288 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22289 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22293 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
22294 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22297 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
22298 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
22299 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
22300 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22301 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
22302 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22303 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
22304 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
22305 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
22307 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22308 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22309 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
22311 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
22312 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
22313 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22314 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
22315 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22316 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22317 of pattern they are set as follows:
22320 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22321 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
22322 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
22325 *queen@*.fict.example
22327 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
22329 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22333 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22334 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
22337 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22338 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22339 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
22340 rewriting rule of the form
22342 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
22344 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
22350 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
22351 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
22352 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22353 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
22354 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22358 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
22359 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
22360 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22361 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
22362 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
22364 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
22366 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
22369 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22370 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22371 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
22372 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
22373 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22374 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
22375 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
22376 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
22377 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
22378 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
22379 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
22380 entry written to the panic log.
22384 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
22385 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
22388 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
22391 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
22393 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
22396 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
22397 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
22401 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
22403 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
22404 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
22405 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
22406 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
22407 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
22408 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
22410 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
22411 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
22412 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
22413 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
22414 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
22415 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
22416 &`h`& rewrite all headers
22417 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
22418 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
22419 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
22421 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
22422 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
22423 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
22425 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
22426 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
22429 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
22430 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
22431 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
22432 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
22433 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
22434 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
22435 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
22436 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
22437 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
22439 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22440 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22441 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
22442 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
22443 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
22444 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
22445 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
22446 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
22449 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
22450 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
22451 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
22452 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
22455 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
22456 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
22457 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
22459 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
22460 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
22461 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
22462 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
22464 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
22465 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
22466 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
22468 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
22469 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
22470 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
22471 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
22473 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
22477 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
22480 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
22481 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
22482 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
22483 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
22484 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
22485 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
22486 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
22487 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
22489 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
22490 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
22494 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
22495 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
22497 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
22498 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
22499 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
22501 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
22502 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
22503 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
22504 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
22505 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
22506 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
22507 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
22508 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
22510 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
22511 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
22513 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
22515 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
22516 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
22518 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
22519 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
22520 messages that originate outside the local host:
22522 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
22523 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
22525 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
22528 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
22529 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
22530 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
22531 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
22532 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
22533 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
22534 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
22535 components. For example, the rule
22537 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
22539 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
22540 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
22541 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
22542 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
22543 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
22544 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
22545 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
22552 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22553 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22555 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
22556 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
22557 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
22558 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
22559 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
22560 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
22561 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
22562 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
22563 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
22564 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
22565 address, domain and error.
22567 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
22568 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
22569 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
22570 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
22571 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
22572 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
22573 log selector is set, the message
22574 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
22575 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
22576 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
22577 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
22579 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
22580 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
22581 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
22582 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
22583 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
22584 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
22585 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
22586 domain are maintained independently.
22588 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
22589 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
22590 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
22591 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
22592 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
22593 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
22594 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
22595 the local address is reached.
22597 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
22598 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
22599 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
22600 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
22601 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
22603 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
22604 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
22605 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
22606 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
22607 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
22608 messages that it should now be retaining.
22612 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
22613 .cindex "retry" "rules"
22614 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
22615 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
22616 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
22617 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
22618 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
22619 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
22620 message's sender, respectively.
22623 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
22624 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
22625 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
22626 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
22627 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
22628 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
22631 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22633 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
22636 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22638 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
22639 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
22642 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
22643 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
22644 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
22645 expressions work in address lists.
22647 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
22648 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
22652 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
22653 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
22654 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
22655 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
22656 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
22657 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
22658 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
22659 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
22660 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
22662 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
22663 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
22664 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
22665 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
22668 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
22669 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
22670 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
22671 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
22672 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
22673 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
22674 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
22675 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
22676 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
22677 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
22682 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
22684 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
22685 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
22686 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
22687 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
22688 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
22689 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
22691 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
22695 and the retry rules are
22697 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
22698 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
22700 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
22701 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
22702 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
22703 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
22704 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
22705 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
22707 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
22708 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
22709 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
22710 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
22712 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
22713 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
22714 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
22716 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
22718 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
22719 textual form of the IP address.
22721 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
22722 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
22723 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
22724 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
22727 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
22728 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
22729 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
22731 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
22732 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
22733 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
22735 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
22736 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
22738 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
22739 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
22742 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
22743 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
22744 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
22745 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
22746 retry rule of this form:
22748 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
22750 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
22751 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
22754 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
22755 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
22756 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
22757 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
22759 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
22760 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
22762 .vitem &%refused_A%&
22763 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
22766 A connection was refused.
22768 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
22769 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
22771 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
22772 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
22774 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
22775 A connection attempt timed out.
22777 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
22778 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
22779 obtained from an MX record.
22781 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
22782 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
22783 obtained from an MX record.
22786 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
22788 .vitem &%tls_required%&
22789 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
22790 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
22791 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
22794 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22797 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
22798 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
22799 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
22800 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22801 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
22802 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
22806 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
22807 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
22808 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
22809 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
22810 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
22814 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
22815 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
22816 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
22818 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
22819 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
22820 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
22821 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
22822 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
22823 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
22824 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
22826 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
22827 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
22830 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
22831 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
22832 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
22837 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
22838 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
22839 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
22840 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
22841 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
22844 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
22846 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
22848 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
22850 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
22851 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
22854 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
22856 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
22857 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
22858 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
22859 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
22860 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
22862 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
22863 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
22865 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
22867 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
22868 list is never matched.
22874 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
22875 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
22876 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
22877 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
22879 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
22881 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
22882 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
22883 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
22884 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
22885 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
22887 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
22888 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
22889 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
22890 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
22891 The available algorithms are:
22894 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
22897 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
22898 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
22899 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
22901 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
22902 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
22903 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
22904 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
22905 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
22906 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
22907 queue processing times.
22910 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
22911 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
22912 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
22913 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
22914 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
22915 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
22916 interval is found. The main configuration variable
22917 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
22918 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
22919 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
22920 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
22921 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
22923 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
22924 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
22925 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
22926 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
22927 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
22928 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
22931 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
22932 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
22933 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
22934 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
22935 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
22936 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
22937 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
22938 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
22939 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
22940 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
22941 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
22942 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
22944 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
22945 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
22946 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
22947 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
22948 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
22949 deliveries that have been deferred.
22952 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
22953 Here are some example retry rules:
22955 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
22956 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
22957 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
22958 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22959 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
22960 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
22962 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
22963 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
22964 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
22965 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
22966 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
22967 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
22968 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
22971 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
22972 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
22973 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
22974 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
22975 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
22977 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
22978 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
22979 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
22980 were not obtained from an MX record.
22982 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
22983 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
22984 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
22985 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
22986 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
22990 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
22991 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
22992 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
22993 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
22994 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
22995 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
22996 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
22997 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
22998 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
22999 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
23000 failing for the first time.
23002 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
23003 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
23004 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
23005 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
23007 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
23008 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
23009 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
23014 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
23015 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
23016 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
23017 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
23018 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
23019 default retry rule:
23021 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
23023 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
23024 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
23025 failure for the recipient address that counts.
23027 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
23028 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
23029 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
23030 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
23031 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
23033 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
23034 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
23035 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
23037 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
23038 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
23039 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
23040 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
23041 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
23042 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
23043 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
23044 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
23046 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
23047 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
23048 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
23049 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
23050 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
23053 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23054 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
23055 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23056 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
23057 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
23058 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
23059 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
23060 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
23061 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
23064 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
23065 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
23066 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
23067 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
23068 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
23069 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
23070 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
23071 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
23074 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
23075 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
23076 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
23077 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
23078 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
23079 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
23080 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
23081 time out the address.
23083 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
23084 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
23085 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
23086 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
23087 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
23088 considered immediately.
23089 .ecindex IIDretconf1
23090 .ecindex IIDregconf2
23097 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23098 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23100 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
23101 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
23102 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
23103 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
23104 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
23105 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
23106 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
23107 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
23108 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
23111 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
23112 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
23115 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
23116 the client's EHLO command.
23118 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
23119 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
23121 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
23122 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
23123 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
23124 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
23125 with the AUTH command.
23127 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
23129 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
23130 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
23131 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
23134 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23135 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23136 unauthenticated connection.
23139 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23140 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23141 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23142 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23144 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23145 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23146 &`Connected to server.example.`&
23147 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
23148 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23149 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23150 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23151 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23156 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23157 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23158 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23159 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23160 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23161 included by setting
23164 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23168 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23169 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23170 the Cyrus SASL authentication library. The third can be configured to support
23171 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23172 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The fourth authenticator
23173 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23175 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23176 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23177 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23178 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23179 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23180 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23181 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23183 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23184 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23185 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23186 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23187 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23188 both sets of options, is required. For example:
23192 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23193 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23195 client_secret = secret2
23197 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23198 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23200 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23201 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23202 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23207 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23208 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23209 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23211 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23212 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23213 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23214 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23215 encrypted by a setting such as:
23217 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
23219 (Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
23220 used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
23221 cipher used for the delivery.)
23224 .option driver authenticators string unset
23225 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23226 authenticators is to be used.
23229 .option public_name authenticators string unset
23230 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23231 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23232 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23233 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23234 defaults to the driver's instance name.
23237 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23238 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23239 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23240 mechanism is not advertised.
23241 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23242 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23243 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23246 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23247 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23248 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23251 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23252 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23253 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23254 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
23255 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
23256 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
23257 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23258 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
23259 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
23263 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
23264 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
23265 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23266 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23267 out the values of variables.
23268 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23269 output, and Exim carries on processing.
23272 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
23273 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23274 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23275 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23276 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
23277 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23278 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23279 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23280 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23283 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23284 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23285 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23286 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
23287 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23288 remembered for later use.
23289 How it is used is described in the following section.
23295 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
23296 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
23297 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23298 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23299 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23303 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23304 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23306 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
23308 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
23309 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23310 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
23311 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
23312 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
23313 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
23314 given for the MAIL command.
23316 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23317 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
23320 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23321 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23322 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
23323 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23324 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
23325 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23326 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
23331 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
23332 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
23333 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
23334 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
23336 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23337 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
23338 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
23339 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
23340 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
23345 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
23346 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
23347 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
23348 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
23352 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
23354 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
23355 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
23358 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
23359 the mechanisms are advertised.
23361 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
23362 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
23363 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
23364 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
23365 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
23366 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
23367 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
23369 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
23371 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
23373 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
23374 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
23375 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
23378 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
23380 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
23381 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
23382 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
23384 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
23385 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
23386 command. This is the case if
23389 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
23391 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
23393 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
23394 server authenticators.
23398 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
23399 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
23400 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
23402 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
23403 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
23404 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
23405 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
23406 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
23407 rejected with a 504 error.
23409 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
23410 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
23411 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
23412 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
23413 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
23414 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
23415 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
23416 no successful authentication.
23421 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
23422 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
23423 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
23424 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
23425 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
23426 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
23427 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
23431 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
23433 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
23434 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
23435 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
23436 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
23437 command line to run this script on such data might be
23439 encode '\0user\0password'
23441 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
23442 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
23443 whose code value is zero.
23445 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
23446 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
23447 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
23448 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
23450 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
23451 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
23452 example, a command such as
23454 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
23456 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
23458 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
23459 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
23461 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
23463 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
23464 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
23465 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
23466 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
23470 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
23471 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
23472 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
23473 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
23474 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
23475 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
23478 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
23479 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
23480 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
23481 of the authenticator.
23484 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23485 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
23486 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
23487 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
23488 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
23489 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
23490 delivery to be deferred.
23492 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
23493 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
23494 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
23497 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
23498 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
23499 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
23500 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
23501 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
23502 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
23503 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
23504 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
23505 deliver the message unauthenticated.
23508 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23509 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
23510 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
23511 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
23512 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
23513 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
23514 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
23515 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
23516 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
23517 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
23518 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
23519 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
23520 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
23527 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23528 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23530 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
23531 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
23532 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
23533 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
23534 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
23535 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
23536 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
23537 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
23538 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
23539 connections as you do for login accounts.
23541 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
23542 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
23543 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
23545 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23546 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
23547 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
23549 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
23550 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
23551 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
23554 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
23555 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23556 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23557 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
23558 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23559 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
23560 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23562 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
23563 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
23564 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
23565 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
23566 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
23567 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
23568 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
23570 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
23571 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
23572 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
23573 string expansions that also use them for other things.
23575 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
23576 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
23577 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
23579 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23580 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
23581 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
23582 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
23583 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
23584 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23585 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
23586 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
23587 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
23588 string as the error text.
23590 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
23591 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
23592 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
23596 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
23597 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
23598 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
23599 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23600 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
23601 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
23602 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
23603 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
23605 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
23606 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
23607 configured as follows:
23611 public_name = PLAIN
23613 server_condition = \
23614 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
23615 server_set_id = $auth2
23617 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
23618 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
23619 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
23620 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
23622 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
23623 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
23624 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
23625 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
23629 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
23631 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
23633 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
23634 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
23638 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
23639 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
23641 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
23642 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
23643 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
23644 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
23645 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
23647 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
23648 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
23649 authenticating clients it could make sense.
23651 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
23652 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
23653 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
23654 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
23655 This is an incorrect example:
23657 server_condition = \
23658 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
23660 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
23661 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
23662 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
23663 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
23664 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
23665 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
23666 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
23668 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
23669 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
23671 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
23672 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
23673 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
23674 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
23675 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
23678 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
23679 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
23680 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
23681 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
23682 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
23683 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
23684 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
23688 public_name = LOGIN
23689 server_prompts = User Name : Password
23690 server_condition = \
23691 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
23692 server_set_id = $auth1
23694 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
23695 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
23696 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
23697 strings are used to obtain two data items.
23699 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
23700 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
23701 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
23702 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
23703 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
23707 public_name = LOGIN
23708 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
23709 server_condition = ${if and{{
23711 ldapauth{user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
23712 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
23713 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
23714 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
23716 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
23717 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
23718 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
23719 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
23720 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
23721 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
23722 uninterpreted string.
23725 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
23726 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
23727 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
23728 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
23729 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
23735 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
23736 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
23737 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
23739 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
23740 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
23741 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
23742 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
23745 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
23746 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
23747 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
23748 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
23749 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
23750 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
23751 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
23752 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
23753 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
23754 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
23755 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
23756 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
23758 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
23759 splitting takes priority and happens first.
23761 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
23762 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
23763 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
23764 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
23767 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
23768 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
23772 public_name = PLAIN
23773 client_send = ^username^mysecret
23775 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
23776 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
23777 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
23781 public_name = LOGIN
23782 client_send = : username : mysecret
23784 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
23785 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
23787 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
23788 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
23793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23794 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23796 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
23797 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23798 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
23799 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
23800 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
23801 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
23802 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
23803 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
23804 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
23805 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
23806 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
23807 available in plain text at either end.
23810 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
23811 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
23812 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
23813 authenticator as a server:
23815 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23816 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23817 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
23818 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
23819 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
23820 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
23821 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
23822 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
23823 returned to the client.
23825 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
23826 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
23827 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
23828 numeric variables for other things.
23830 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
23831 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
23832 user name, authentication fails.
23836 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23837 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
23838 server_set_id = $auth1
23840 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23841 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
23842 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
23843 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
23847 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23848 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
23850 server_set_id = $auth1
23852 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
23853 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
23856 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
23857 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
23858 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
23862 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
23863 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
23864 computing the response to the server's challenge.
23867 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23868 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
23869 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
23873 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23874 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
23875 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
23876 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
23877 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
23878 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
23879 send the message to the current server.
23881 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
23886 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23888 client_secret = secret
23890 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
23891 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
23895 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23896 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23898 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
23899 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
23900 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
23901 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
23903 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
23904 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
23906 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
23907 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
23908 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
23909 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
23910 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
23912 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
23913 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
23914 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
23915 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
23917 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
23918 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
23919 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
23920 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
23921 depending on the driver you are using.
23923 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
23924 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
23925 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
23926 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
23927 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
23928 implementation. For example, for Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
23929 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
23930 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
23931 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
23934 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
23935 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
23936 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
23937 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
23938 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
23939 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
23943 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
23944 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
23945 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
23946 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
23949 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
23950 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
23951 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
23952 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
23956 driver = cyrus_sasl
23957 public_name = X-ANYTHING
23958 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
23959 server_set_id = $auth1
23962 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string unset
23963 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
23966 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
23967 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
23970 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
23971 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
23972 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
23973 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
23976 driver = cyrus_sasl
23977 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23978 server_set_id = $auth1
23981 driver = cyrus_sasl
23982 public_name = PLAIN
23983 server_set_id = $auth2
23985 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
23986 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
23987 but it is present in many binary distributions.
23988 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
23989 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
23994 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23995 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23996 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
23997 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
23998 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
23999 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
24000 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
24001 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
24002 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
24003 authenticator only. There is only one option:
24005 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
24007 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
24008 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
24009 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
24010 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
24014 public_name = PLAIN
24015 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24016 server_set_id = $auth2
24021 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24022 server_set_id = $auth1
24024 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
24025 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
24026 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
24027 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
24028 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
24029 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
24030 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
24031 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
24034 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24035 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24037 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
24038 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
24039 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
24040 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
24041 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
24042 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
24043 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
24044 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
24045 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
24046 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
24047 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
24048 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
24049 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
24053 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
24054 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
24056 The server sends back a challenge.
24058 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
24059 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
24062 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
24066 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
24067 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
24068 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
24070 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
24071 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
24072 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
24073 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
24074 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
24075 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
24076 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
24077 for other things. For example:
24082 server_password = \
24083 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
24085 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
24086 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
24092 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
24093 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
24094 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
24098 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
24099 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
24102 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
24103 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
24106 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
24107 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
24108 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
24114 client_username = msn/msn_username
24115 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
24116 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
24118 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
24119 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
24125 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24126 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24128 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
24129 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
24130 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
24131 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
24132 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
24135 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
24136 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
24137 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
24138 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
24139 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
24140 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
24141 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
24142 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
24143 certificates are used.
24145 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
24146 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
24147 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
24148 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
24149 between them is encrypted.
24151 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
24152 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
24153 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
24154 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
24157 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
24158 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
24159 in order to get TLS to work.
24163 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
24165 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
24166 .cindex "smtps protocol"
24167 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
24168 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
24169 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
24170 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
24171 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
24172 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
24173 allocated for this purpose.
24175 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
24176 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
24177 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
24178 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
24180 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
24182 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
24183 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
24184 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
24185 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
24186 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
24189 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
24190 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
24197 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
24198 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
24199 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
24200 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
24201 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
24205 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
24209 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
24210 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
24212 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
24215 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
24216 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
24218 The &%tls_dhparam%& option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
24219 facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
24220 changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
24222 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24223 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
24224 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
24225 affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
24227 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
24228 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is
24229 more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
24230 life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
24231 underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
24232 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
24235 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
24236 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
24240 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECID181"
24241 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
24242 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
24243 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
24244 &_gnutls-params_&. The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
24245 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
24246 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
24247 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
24248 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
24249 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
24250 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
24252 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
24253 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
24254 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
24255 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
24256 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
24257 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
24258 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
24259 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
24261 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
24262 in &_gnutls-params_& in PEM format, which means that they can be generated
24263 externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
24265 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
24266 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
24267 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
24268 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
24272 # chown exim:exim new-params
24273 # chmod 0400 new-params
24274 # certtool --generate-privkey --bits 512 >new-params
24275 # echo "" >>new-params
24276 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 1024 >> new-params
24277 # mv new-params gnutls-params
24279 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
24280 stalling is removed.
24283 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
24284 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
24285 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
24286 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
24287 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
24288 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
24289 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
24290 directly to this function call. The following quotation from the OpenSSL
24291 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
24294 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
24296 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
24297 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
24298 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
24301 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
24302 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
24303 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
24307 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
24310 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
24311 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
24314 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
24315 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
24317 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
24318 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
24321 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
24322 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
24323 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
24324 not be moved to the end of the list.
24329 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
24331 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
24332 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
24333 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
24334 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
24335 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
24336 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
24337 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to specify separate lists of permitted key
24338 exchange methods, main cipher algorithms, MAC algorithms, and protocols.
24339 Unfortunately, these lists are numerical, and the library does not have a
24340 function for turning names into numbers. Consequently, lists of recognized
24341 names have to be built into the application. The permitted key exchange
24342 methods, ciphers, and MAC algorithms may be used in any combination to form a
24343 cipher suite. This is unlike OpenSSL, where complete cipher suite names are
24344 passed to its control function.
24346 For compatibility with OpenSSL, the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option can be set
24347 to complete cipher suite names such as RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA, but for GnuTLS this
24348 option controls only the cipher algorithms. Exim searches each item in the
24349 list for the name of an available algorithm. For example, if the list
24350 contains RSA_AES_SHA, then AES is recognized, and the behaviour is exactly
24351 the same as if just AES were given.
24353 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_kx%&"
24354 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_mac%&"
24355 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&"
24356 There are additional options called &%gnutls_require_kx%&,
24357 &%gnutls_require_mac%&, and &%gnutls_require_protocols%& that can be used to
24358 restrict the key exchange methods, MAC algorithms, and protocols, respectively.
24359 These options are ignored if OpenSSL is in use.
24361 All four options are available as global options, controlling how Exim
24362 behaves as a server, and also as options of the &(smtp)& transport, controlling
24363 how Exim behaves as a client. All the values are string expanded. After
24364 expansion, the values must be colon-separated lists, though the separator
24365 can be changed in the usual way.
24367 Each of the four lists starts out with a default set of algorithms. If the
24368 first item in a list does &'not'& start with an exclamation mark, all the
24369 default items are deleted. In this case, only those that are explicitly
24370 specified can be used. If the first item in a list &'does'& start with an
24371 exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
24373 Then, any item that starts with an exclamation mark causes the relevant
24374 entry to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start with an
24375 exclamation mark causes a new entry to be added to the list. Unrecognized
24376 items in the list are ignored. Thus:
24378 tls_require_ciphers = !ARCFOUR
24380 allows all the defaults except ARCFOUR, whereas
24382 tls_require_ciphers = AES : 3DES
24384 allows only cipher suites that use AES or 3DES.
24386 For &%tls_require_ciphers%& the recognized names are AES_256, AES_128, AES
24387 (both of the preceding), 3DES, ARCFOUR_128, ARCFOUR_40, and ARCFOUR (both of
24388 the preceding). The default list does not contain all of these; it just has
24389 AES_256, AES_128, 3DES, and ARCFOUR_128.
24391 For &%gnutls_require_kx%&, the recognized names are DHE_RSA, RSA (which
24392 includes DHE_RSA), DHE_DSS, and DHE (which includes both DHE_RSA and
24393 DHE_DSS). The default list contains RSA, DHE_DSS, DHE_RSA.
24395 For &%gnutls_require_mac%&, the recognized names are SHA (synonym SHA1), and
24396 MD5. The default list contains SHA, MD5.
24398 For &%gnutls_require_protocols%&, the recognized names are TLS1 and SSL3.
24399 The default list contains TLS1, SSL3.
24401 In a server, the order of items in these lists is unimportant. The server
24402 advertises the availability of all the relevant cipher suites. However, in a
24403 client, the order in the &%tls_require_ciphers%& list specifies a preference
24404 order for the cipher algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
24405 also advertised by the server is tried first. The default order is as listed
24410 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
24411 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
24412 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
24413 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
24414 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
24415 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
24416 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
24417 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
24419 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
24420 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
24421 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
24424 554 Security failure
24426 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
24427 rejected with a 554 error code.
24429 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
24430 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
24431 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
24432 without some further configuration at the server end.
24434 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
24435 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
24437 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
24438 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
24440 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
24441 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
24442 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
24443 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
24444 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
24445 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
24446 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
24447 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
24448 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
24449 the server's certificate.
24451 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
24452 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
24453 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
24455 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
24456 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
24457 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
24460 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
24461 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
24462 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
24464 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
24466 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
24467 with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
24468 suites that the server supports. See the command
24472 for a way of generating this data. At present, &%tls_dhparam%& is used only
24473 when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
24475 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
24476 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
24477 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
24478 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
24479 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
24481 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24482 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24483 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
24484 The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
24485 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
24486 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
24487 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
24488 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
24489 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
24490 (For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
24493 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
24494 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
24495 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
24496 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
24497 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
24498 documentation for more details.
24501 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
24502 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
24503 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
24504 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
24505 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
24506 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
24507 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
24508 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
24509 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
24510 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
24511 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
24512 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
24514 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
24517 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
24518 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
24519 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
24521 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
24523 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
24525 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
24526 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
24527 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
24528 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
24529 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
24530 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
24531 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
24532 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
24533 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
24534 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
24536 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24537 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
24538 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
24539 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
24541 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24542 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
24543 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
24544 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
24545 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
24546 certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
24549 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
24550 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
24551 .cindex "revocation list"
24552 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
24553 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
24554 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
24555 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
24556 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
24557 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
24561 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
24562 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24563 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24564 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24565 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
24566 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
24567 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
24568 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
24569 within the &(smtp)& transport.
24571 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
24572 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
24573 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
24574 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
24575 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
24577 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
24578 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
24579 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
24580 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
24581 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
24584 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
24585 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
24586 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
24587 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
24588 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
24589 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
24590 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
24591 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
24592 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24593 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24596 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
24597 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
24598 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
24599 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
24601 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
24602 must name a file or,
24603 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
24604 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
24605 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
24606 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
24609 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
24610 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
24611 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
24612 alternative hosts, if any.
24615 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
24616 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
24617 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
24621 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24622 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
24623 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
24624 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
24625 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
24627 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24628 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24629 Before an SMTP connection is established, the &$tls_cipher$& and &$tls_peerdn$&
24630 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
24631 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
24632 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
24633 outgoing connection.
24637 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
24639 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
24640 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24641 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
24642 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
24643 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
24644 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
24645 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
24646 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
24647 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
24648 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
24649 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
24651 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
24652 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
24653 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
24654 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
24655 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
24656 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
24657 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
24658 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
24659 and delay other deliveries to that host.
24661 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
24662 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
24663 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
24664 information is recorded.
24666 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
24667 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
24668 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
24673 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
24674 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
24675 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
24676 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
24677 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
24678 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
24679 to Apache, currently at
24681 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
24683 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
24684 links to further files.
24685 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
24686 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
24687 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
24689 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
24693 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
24694 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
24695 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
24696 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
24697 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
24698 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
24699 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
24700 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
24701 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
24702 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
24703 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
24704 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
24705 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
24708 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
24709 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
24710 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
24711 with OpenSSL, like this:
24713 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
24716 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
24717 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
24718 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
24719 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
24720 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
24721 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
24722 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
24724 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
24725 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
24726 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
24728 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
24729 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
24730 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
24731 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
24732 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
24733 signed with that self-signed certificate.
24735 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
24736 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
24737 Open-source PKI book, available online at
24738 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
24739 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
24740 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
24744 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24745 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24747 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
24748 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
24749 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
24750 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
24751 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
24752 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
24753 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
24754 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
24755 one very small ACL:
24759 accept hosts = one.host.only
24761 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
24762 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
24764 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
24765 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
24766 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
24767 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
24768 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
24769 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
24770 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
24771 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
24774 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
24775 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
24776 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
24777 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
24778 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
24782 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
24783 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
24784 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
24785 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
24786 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
24787 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24788 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
24789 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
24790 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24791 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24792 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
24793 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24794 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
24795 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
24796 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
24797 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24798 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24799 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
24802 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
24803 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
24804 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
24805 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
24806 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
24807 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
24808 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
24809 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
24810 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
24811 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
24812 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
24813 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
24814 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
24815 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
24816 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
24817 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
24818 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
24819 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
24822 For example, if you set
24824 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
24826 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
24827 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
24828 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
24829 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
24830 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
24831 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
24832 testing as possible at RCPT time.
24835 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
24836 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24837 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
24838 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
24839 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
24840 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
24841 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
24842 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
24843 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
24844 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
24845 in any of these ACLs.
24847 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
24848 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
24849 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
24850 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
24851 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
24852 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
24853 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
24854 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
24856 control = suppress_local_fixups
24858 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
24859 run, it is too late.
24861 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24862 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24864 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
24865 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
24866 temporary error for these kinds of message.
24869 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
24870 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24871 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
24872 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
24873 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
24874 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
24875 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
24876 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
24877 &%smtp_banner%& option.
24880 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
24881 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24882 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24883 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
24884 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
24885 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
24886 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
24887 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
24888 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
24890 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
24891 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
24892 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
24893 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
24897 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
24898 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24899 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
24900 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
24901 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
24902 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
24903 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
24904 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
24905 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
24906 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
24908 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
24909 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
24910 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
24911 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
24912 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
24913 associated with the DATA command.
24915 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
24916 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
24917 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
24918 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
24919 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
24923 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
24924 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24925 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24928 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
24929 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24930 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
24931 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
24932 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
24933 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
24935 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
24936 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
24937 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
24938 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
24940 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
24941 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
24943 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
24944 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
24947 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
24948 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
24949 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
24950 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
24951 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
24954 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
24955 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
24956 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
24957 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
24958 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
24959 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
24960 situation even worse.
24962 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
24963 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
24964 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
24967 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
24968 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
24969 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
24970 connection. The possible values are:
24972 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
24973 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
24974 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
24975 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
24976 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
24977 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
24978 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
24979 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
24980 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
24981 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
24983 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
24984 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
24985 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
24986 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
24987 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
24991 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
24992 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
24993 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
24994 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
24996 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
24997 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
24999 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
25000 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
25001 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
25002 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
25003 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
25005 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
25006 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
25007 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
25010 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
25011 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
25012 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
25013 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
25014 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
25015 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
25017 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
25018 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
25019 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
25021 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
25022 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
25023 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
25024 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
25026 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
25027 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
25028 matches the string.
25030 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
25031 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
25032 want to have something like
25034 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
25036 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
25037 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
25043 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
25044 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
25045 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
25046 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
25047 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
25048 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
25049 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
25050 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
25051 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
25053 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
25054 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
25055 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
25058 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
25059 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
25060 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
25061 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
25063 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
25064 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
25065 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
25066 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
25067 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
25068 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
25069 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
25072 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
25073 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
25074 recipients; it may create new recipients.
25078 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
25079 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
25080 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
25081 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
25082 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
25083 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
25085 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
25086 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
25087 used to accept or reject anything.
25089 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
25090 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
25091 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
25092 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
25094 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
25095 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
25096 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
25097 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
25098 configuration file.
25103 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
25104 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
25106 .vindex &$local_part$&
25107 .vindex &$sender_address$&
25108 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
25109 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25110 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
25111 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
25112 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
25113 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
25114 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
25115 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25117 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
25118 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
25119 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
25122 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
25123 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
25124 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
25125 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
25126 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
25129 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
25130 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
25131 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
25132 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
25133 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
25134 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
25135 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
25136 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
25142 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
25143 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
25144 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
25145 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25146 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
25147 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
25148 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25149 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
25150 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
25151 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
25152 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
25153 unencrypted connections.
25156 accept encrypted = *
25157 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
25159 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
25161 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
25162 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
25163 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
25164 option to do this.)
25168 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
25169 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
25170 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
25171 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
25172 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
25173 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
25174 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
25176 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
25177 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
25178 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
25181 deny dnslists = list1.example
25182 dnslists = list2.example
25184 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
25185 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
25186 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
25187 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
25188 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
25191 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
25192 The ACL verbs are as follows:
25195 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
25196 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
25197 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
25198 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
25199 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
25200 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
25201 check a RCPT command:
25203 accept domains = +local_domains
25207 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
25208 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
25209 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
25210 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
25213 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
25214 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
25215 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
25218 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
25219 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
25220 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
25221 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
25222 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
25223 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
25225 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
25226 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
25228 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
25229 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
25230 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
25232 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
25233 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
25234 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
25239 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
25240 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
25241 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
25242 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
25243 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
25244 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
25245 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
25249 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
25250 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
25251 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
25254 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
25256 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
25260 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
25261 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
25262 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
25263 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
25264 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
25265 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
25266 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
25267 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
25268 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
25270 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
25271 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
25272 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
25276 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
25277 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
25278 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
25280 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
25281 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
25283 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
25284 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
25287 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
25288 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
25289 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
25290 example, when checking a RCPT command,
25292 require message = Sender did not verify
25295 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
25296 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
25297 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
25298 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
25301 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25302 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
25303 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
25304 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
25305 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
25306 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
25307 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
25309 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
25310 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
25311 &%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
25312 condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
25313 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25315 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
25316 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
25317 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
25318 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
25319 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
25320 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
25324 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25325 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
25326 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
25327 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
25329 warn !verify = sender
25330 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
25334 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
25336 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
25337 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
25338 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
25339 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
25340 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
25344 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
25345 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
25346 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
25347 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
25348 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
25349 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
25350 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
25351 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
25352 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
25353 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
25355 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
25356 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
25357 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
25358 on the same SMTP connection.
25360 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
25361 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
25362 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
25365 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
25366 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
25367 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
25369 accept hosts = whatever
25370 set acl_m4 = some value
25371 accept authenticated = *
25372 set acl_c_auth = yes
25374 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
25375 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
25376 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
25378 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
25379 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
25380 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
25381 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
25382 error is generated.
25384 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
25385 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
25388 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
25389 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
25390 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
25391 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
25393 deny domains = *.dom.example
25394 !verify = recipient
25396 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
25397 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
25398 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
25399 two statements are equivalent:
25401 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
25402 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
25404 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
25405 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
25407 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
25408 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
25409 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
25411 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25412 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
25413 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25414 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
25416 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
25417 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
25418 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
25419 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
25420 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
25421 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
25422 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
25424 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
25425 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
25426 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
25427 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
25428 message is handled.
25430 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
25431 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
25432 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
25433 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
25435 require message = Can't verify sender
25437 message = Can't verify recipient
25439 message = This message cannot be used
25441 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
25442 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
25443 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
25444 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
25445 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
25446 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
25448 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
25449 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
25450 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
25451 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
25454 !senders = *@my.domain.example
25455 message = Invalid sender from client host
25457 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
25458 by which time Exim has set up the message.
25462 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
25463 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
25464 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
25467 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25468 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
25469 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
25470 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25472 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25473 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
25474 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
25475 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
25476 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
25477 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
25478 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
25479 write rather ugly lines like this:
25481 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
25483 Instead, all you need is
25485 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
25488 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25489 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25490 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
25491 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
25492 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
25493 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
25494 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
25495 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
25497 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
25498 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
25499 in several different ways. For example:
25501 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
25502 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
25503 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
25507 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
25509 accept ...some conditions
25510 control = queue_only
25512 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
25513 other words, when the conditions are all true.
25516 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
25518 accept ...some conditions...
25519 control = queue_only
25520 ...some more conditions...
25522 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
25523 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
25524 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
25528 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
25529 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
25532 warn ...some conditions...
25536 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
25537 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
25541 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
25542 &%require%& verb. For example:
25544 require control = no_multiline_responses
25548 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
25549 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
25551 This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
25552 interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
25553 option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
25554 instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
25555 as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
25556 flushed before the delay is imposed.
25558 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
25561 deny ...some conditions...
25564 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
25565 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
25568 ...some conditions...
25570 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
25571 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
25573 warn ...some conditions...
25579 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
25580 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
25581 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
25582 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
25583 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
25584 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
25585 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
25589 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
25590 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
25591 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
25592 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
25593 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
25594 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
25595 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
25598 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25599 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
25600 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
25601 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
25603 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
25604 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
25606 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
25609 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
25610 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
25612 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
25613 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
25614 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
25617 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
25618 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
25619 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
25620 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
25621 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
25622 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
25625 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25626 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
25627 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
25630 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
25631 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
25632 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
25633 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
25634 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
25635 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
25637 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
25638 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
25639 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
25640 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
25641 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
25642 logging rejections.
25645 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
25646 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
25647 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
25648 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
25649 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
25650 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
25651 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
25652 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
25654 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
25655 &` log_reject_target =`&
25657 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
25658 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
25662 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25663 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
25664 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
25665 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
25666 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
25667 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
25668 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
25671 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
25672 &` control = freeze`&
25673 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
25675 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
25676 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
25677 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
25680 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
25681 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
25685 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25686 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25687 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
25688 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
25689 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
25690 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
25691 &%accept%& for details.)
25693 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
25694 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
25695 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
25696 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
25697 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
25699 require message = Host not recognized
25702 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
25705 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
25706 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
25707 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
25708 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
25709 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
25710 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
25711 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
25712 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
25713 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
25716 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
25717 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
25718 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
25720 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
25721 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
25723 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
25724 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
25725 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
25728 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
25729 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
25731 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
25732 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
25733 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
25736 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25737 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
25738 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
25739 However, the original message is available in the variable
25740 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
25741 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
25742 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
25743 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
25745 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
25746 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
25747 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
25748 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
25749 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
25750 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
25754 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
25755 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
25756 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
25757 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
25764 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
25765 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25766 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
25769 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
25770 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
25771 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
25772 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
25773 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
25774 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
25775 not work without it. For example:
25777 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
25778 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
25780 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
25781 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
25782 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
25783 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
25784 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
25787 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
25788 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
25789 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
25790 .cindex "case of local parts"
25791 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25792 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
25793 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
25794 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
25795 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
25796 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
25799 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
25800 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
25801 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
25802 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
25803 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
25805 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
25806 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
25809 warn control = caseful_local_part
25810 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
25812 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
25814 control = caselower_local_part
25816 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
25817 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
25819 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
25820 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
25821 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
25822 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
25823 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
25824 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
25825 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
25826 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
25827 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
25831 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
25832 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
25833 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
25836 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
25837 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
25838 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
25839 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
25840 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
25841 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
25842 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
25843 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
25845 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25846 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
25847 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
25848 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
25849 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
25850 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
25854 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
25855 .cindex "fake defer"
25856 .cindex "defer, fake"
25857 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
25858 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
25859 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
25860 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
25861 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
25863 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
25864 .cindex "fake rejection"
25865 .cindex "rejection, fake"
25866 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
25867 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
25868 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
25869 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
25870 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25871 the same SMTP connection.
25873 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
25874 message is supplied, the following is used:
25876 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
25877 550-kept for evaluation.
25878 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
25879 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
25881 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
25883 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
25884 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
25885 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25886 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25887 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
25888 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
25891 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
25892 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
25893 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
25894 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
25896 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
25897 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
25898 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
25899 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25900 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
25901 disables such output flushing.
25903 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
25904 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
25905 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
25906 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25907 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
25908 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
25910 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
25911 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
25912 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
25913 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
25914 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
25915 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
25916 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25917 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
25918 to be useful in production.
25920 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
25921 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
25922 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
25923 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
25924 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
25926 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
25927 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
25928 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
25929 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
25930 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
25931 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
25934 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
25935 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
25936 verification failed"&) is sent.
25938 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
25942 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
25943 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
25945 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
25946 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
25947 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
25948 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
25949 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
25950 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
25951 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
25953 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
25954 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
25955 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
25956 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25957 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25958 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
25959 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
25960 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
25961 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
25962 same SMTP connection.
25964 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
25965 .cindex "message" "submission"
25966 .cindex "submission mode"
25967 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
25968 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
25969 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
25970 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
25971 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
25972 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
25973 late (the message has already been created).
25975 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
25976 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
25977 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
25978 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
25979 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
25981 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
25982 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
25983 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
25984 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
25985 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
25988 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
25989 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
25991 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
25993 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
25996 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
25997 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
25998 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
25999 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
26002 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
26003 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
26007 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
26008 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
26011 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
26013 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
26014 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
26016 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
26018 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
26023 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
26024 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
26025 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
26026 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
26027 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
26028 to an incoming message, as in this example:
26030 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26031 dialup.mail-abuse.org
26032 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
26034 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
26035 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
26036 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
26037 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
26038 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
26041 If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
26042 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
26043 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
26044 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
26046 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
26047 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
26048 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
26049 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
26050 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
26051 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
26052 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
26053 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
26054 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
26055 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
26056 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
26058 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
26059 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
26060 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
26061 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
26062 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
26063 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
26064 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
26065 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
26066 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
26068 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
26069 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
26071 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
26072 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
26074 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
26075 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
26077 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
26078 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
26079 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
26080 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
26083 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26084 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
26085 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
26086 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
26087 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
26088 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
26089 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
26092 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
26093 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
26094 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
26095 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
26096 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
26098 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
26099 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
26100 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
26101 to be a header name first.) For example:
26103 warn add_header = \
26104 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
26106 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
26107 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
26108 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
26109 up in reverse order.
26111 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
26112 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
26113 system filter or in a router or transport.
26118 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
26119 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
26120 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
26121 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
26122 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
26123 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26125 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
26126 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
26127 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
26128 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
26129 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
26130 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
26131 The conditions are as follows:
26135 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
26136 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
26137 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
26138 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
26139 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
26140 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
26141 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
26142 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
26143 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
26144 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
26145 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
26147 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
26148 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
26149 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
26150 conditions are tested.
26152 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
26153 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
26154 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
26155 for different local users or different local domains.
26157 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26158 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
26159 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
26160 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
26161 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
26162 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
26163 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
26168 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
26169 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
26170 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
26171 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
26172 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
26173 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
26174 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
26175 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
26176 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
26177 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
26178 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
26179 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
26182 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
26183 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
26184 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26185 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26186 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
26187 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
26188 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
26189 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26191 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
26192 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
26193 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26194 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
26195 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
26197 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
26198 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
26199 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26200 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26201 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26202 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
26203 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
26204 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
26205 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
26206 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
26208 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26209 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
26210 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
26211 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
26212 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
26213 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
26214 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
26215 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
26216 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
26219 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
26220 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
26223 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26224 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
26225 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
26226 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
26227 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
26228 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
26229 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
26235 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
26236 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
26237 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
26238 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
26239 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
26240 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
26241 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
26243 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26245 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
26246 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
26247 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
26249 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
26250 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
26251 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
26252 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
26253 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
26254 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
26256 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
26257 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
26259 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26260 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
26262 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
26263 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
26264 statement can then check the IP address.
26266 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
26267 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
26268 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
26269 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
26271 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
26272 message = $host_data
26274 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
26276 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
26277 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
26278 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
26279 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
26280 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
26281 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
26282 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
26283 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
26284 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
26285 the next &%local_parts%& test.
26287 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
26288 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
26289 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
26290 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
26291 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26292 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
26293 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26295 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26296 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
26297 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26298 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26299 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26300 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
26301 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
26304 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
26305 .cindex "rate limiting"
26306 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
26307 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
26309 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26310 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
26311 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
26312 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
26313 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
26314 recipient address against a list of recipients.
26316 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26317 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
26318 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26319 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26320 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
26321 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
26322 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26324 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26325 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
26326 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26327 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
26328 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26329 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
26330 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
26331 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
26332 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
26333 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
26334 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
26335 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
26336 influence the sender checking.
26338 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26339 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26341 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26342 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
26343 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26344 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
26345 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
26346 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
26350 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26351 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26353 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
26354 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
26355 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
26356 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26357 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
26358 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26360 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
26361 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26362 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26363 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26364 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
26365 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
26366 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
26367 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
26368 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
26369 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26371 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
26372 .cindex "CSA verification"
26373 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
26374 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
26375 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
26377 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
26378 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26379 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
26380 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
26381 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
26382 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
26383 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26384 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26385 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
26386 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
26387 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
26388 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
26389 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
26390 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
26391 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
26393 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
26394 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
26395 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
26396 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
26399 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
26400 !verify = header_sender
26403 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
26404 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26405 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
26406 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
26407 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
26408 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26409 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26410 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
26411 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
26412 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
26413 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
26414 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26417 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
26418 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
26422 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
26423 common as they used to be.
26425 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
26426 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26427 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
26428 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
26429 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
26430 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
26431 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
26432 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
26433 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
26434 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
26435 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
26436 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
26437 independently of this condition.
26439 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
26440 option), this condition is always true.
26443 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
26444 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
26445 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
26446 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
26447 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
26448 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
26449 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
26450 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
26451 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
26453 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
26454 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
26457 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
26458 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26459 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
26460 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
26461 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
26462 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26463 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
26464 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
26465 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
26466 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
26467 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
26468 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
26469 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
26470 value for the child address.
26472 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
26473 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26474 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
26475 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
26476 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
26477 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
26478 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
26479 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
26480 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
26481 original IP address.
26483 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
26484 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
26486 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
26487 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26488 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
26489 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
26490 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
26491 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
26492 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
26493 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
26494 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
26496 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26497 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
26498 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
26499 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
26500 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
26501 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
26502 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
26504 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
26505 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
26506 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
26508 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
26509 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26510 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
26511 verified as a sender.
26516 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
26517 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26518 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26519 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26520 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
26521 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
26522 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
26523 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
26524 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
26525 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
26527 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
26528 dialups.mail-abuse.org
26530 the following records are looked up:
26532 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26533 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
26535 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
26536 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
26537 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
26538 use two separate conditions:
26540 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26541 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26543 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
26544 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
26545 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
26548 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
26549 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
26550 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
26551 following special items in the list:
26553 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
26554 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
26555 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
26557 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
26558 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
26559 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
26560 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
26562 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
26564 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
26565 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
26567 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26568 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
26569 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26571 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
26572 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
26573 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
26574 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
26578 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
26579 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
26580 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
26581 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
26582 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
26584 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
26586 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
26587 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
26588 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
26589 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
26594 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
26595 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
26596 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
26597 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
26598 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
26599 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
26600 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
26602 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
26603 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26605 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
26606 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
26607 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
26608 up by this example is
26610 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
26612 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
26613 addresses. For example:
26615 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26616 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26618 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
26619 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
26624 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
26625 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
26626 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
26627 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
26628 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
26629 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
26630 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
26631 either to double the separators like this:
26633 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
26635 or to change the separator character, like this:
26637 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
26639 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
26640 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
26641 occurs. Consider this condition:
26643 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
26645 The DNS lookups that occur are:
26647 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
26648 a.domain.black.list.tld
26650 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
26651 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
26652 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
26653 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
26654 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
26655 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
26656 error for a previous item.
26658 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
26659 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
26661 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
26662 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
26664 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
26665 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
26667 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
26668 $sender_address_domain \
26669 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
26671 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
26672 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
26673 $sender_address_domain} }} }
26675 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
26676 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
26677 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
26678 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
26680 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
26682 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
26683 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
26685 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
26686 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
26691 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
26692 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
26693 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
26694 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
26695 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
26696 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
26700 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
26702 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
26703 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
26704 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
26706 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
26707 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
26708 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
26711 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
26712 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
26713 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
26714 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
26715 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
26716 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
26717 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
26718 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
26719 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
26720 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
26721 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
26722 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
26723 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
26724 cases, for example:
26726 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
26728 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
26729 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
26730 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
26731 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
26733 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
26735 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
26736 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
26738 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
26739 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
26740 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
26741 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
26742 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
26745 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
26746 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
26747 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
26749 deny hosts = !+local_networks
26750 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
26752 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
26757 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
26758 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
26759 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
26760 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
26763 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
26765 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
26766 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
26767 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
26768 describes how multiple records are handled.
26770 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
26771 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
26772 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
26774 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26776 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
26777 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
26778 first. For example:
26780 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
26781 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
26784 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
26785 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
26786 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
26787 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
26788 tested. For example:
26790 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
26792 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
26793 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
26794 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
26796 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26798 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
26803 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
26804 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
26807 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26809 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26810 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
26812 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26814 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26815 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
26816 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
26817 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
26819 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
26820 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
26822 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
26823 previous example is precisely equivalent to
26825 deny dnslists = a.b.c
26826 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26828 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
26829 Consider this example:
26831 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26833 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
26836 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
26838 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26840 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
26841 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
26842 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
26844 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
26849 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
26850 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
26851 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
26852 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
26853 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
26854 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
26856 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
26858 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
26859 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
26860 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
26861 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
26862 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
26863 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
26866 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
26867 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
26868 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26870 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
26871 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
26874 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
26876 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26877 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
26879 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
26881 for the condition to be true.
26884 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
26885 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
26887 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
26888 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
26890 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
26892 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26893 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26895 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
26896 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
26898 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
26900 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26901 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
26903 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26905 for the condition to be false.
26907 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
26908 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
26913 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
26914 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
26915 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
26916 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
26917 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
26918 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
26919 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
26920 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
26921 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
26924 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
26925 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
26926 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
26927 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
26928 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
26929 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
26930 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
26933 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
26934 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
26936 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
26937 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26939 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
26940 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
26941 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
26942 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
26943 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
26944 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
26946 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
26947 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
26948 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
26950 reject dnslists = \
26951 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
26952 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
26953 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
26954 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26956 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
26957 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
26958 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
26962 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
26963 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
26964 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
26965 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
26966 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
26967 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
26969 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
26970 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26972 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
26973 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
26974 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
26976 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
26978 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
26979 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
26981 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
26982 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
26984 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
26985 dnslists = some.list.example
26988 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
26989 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
26990 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
26991 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
26992 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
26993 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
26994 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
26995 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
26996 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
26997 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
26999 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
27001 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
27002 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
27004 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
27005 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
27006 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
27009 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
27010 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
27011 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
27012 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
27013 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
27014 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
27015 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
27016 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
27017 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
27019 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
27020 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
27021 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
27022 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
27024 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
27025 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
27026 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
27027 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
27028 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
27029 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
27030 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
27031 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
27032 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
27033 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
27035 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
27036 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
27037 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
27040 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& and the options onto the
27041 lookup key because they alter the meaning of the stored data. This is not true
27042 for the limit &'m'&, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will
27043 still remember clients' past behaviour, but if you alter the other ratelimit
27044 parameters Exim forgets past behaviour.
27046 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to three options. One option
27047 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, and the second specifies how Exim
27048 handles excessively fast clients. The third option can be &`noupdate`&, to
27049 disable updating of the ratelimiting database (see section &<<rearatdat>>&).
27050 The options are separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may
27051 appear in any order.
27053 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
27054 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate.
27056 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
27057 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified.
27059 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. Note that it is
27060 best to use this option in the DATA ACL; if it is used in an earlier ACL it
27061 relies on the SIZE parameter specified by the client in its MAIL command,
27062 which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can follow the limit &'m'&
27063 in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits in kilobytes,
27064 megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
27066 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which
27067 recipients are accepted. To be effective, it would need to be used in
27068 either the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& or the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. In the
27069 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACL, the number of recipients is incremented by one.
27070 In the case of a locally submitted message in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL,
27071 the number of recipients is incremented by the &%$recipients_count%&
27072 for the entire message. Note that in either case the rate limiting
27073 engine will see a message with many recipients as a large high-speed
27076 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
27077 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the SMTP command rate.
27078 This command is essentially an alias of &%per_rcpt%& to make it clear
27079 that the effect is to limit the rate at which individual commands,
27080 rather than recipients, are accepted.
27082 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratophanfas"
27083 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
27084 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
27085 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& options. This is independent of the other
27086 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
27087 rest of the ACL. The default mode is leaky, which avoids a sender's
27088 over-aggressive retry rate preventing it from getting any email through.
27090 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
27091 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
27092 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
27093 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
27094 counter-measures by the ACL until it slows down below the maximum rate. If
27095 the client stops attempting to send email for the time specified in the &'p'&
27096 parameter then its computed rate will decay exponentially to 37% of its peak
27097 value. You can work out the time (the number of smoothing periods) that a
27098 client is subjected to counter-measures after an over-limit burst with this
27101 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
27103 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
27104 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
27105 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
27106 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
27107 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
27108 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
27109 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
27111 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
27112 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
27113 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
27114 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
27115 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
27116 message. For example:
27118 # Log all senders' rates
27119 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
27120 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
27122 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
27123 # at the decimal point.
27124 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
27125 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
27126 $sender_rate_limit }s
27128 # Keep authenticated users under control
27129 deny authenticated = *
27130 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
27132 # System-wide rate limit
27133 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
27134 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
27136 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
27137 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
27138 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
27139 messages per $sender_rate_period
27140 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
27141 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
27142 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
27144 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
27145 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
27146 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
27147 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
27148 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
27149 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
27150 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
27153 .section "Reading ratelimit data without updating" "rearatdat"
27154 .cindex "rate limitint" "reading data without updating"
27155 If the &%noupdate%& option is present on a &%ratelimit%& ACL condition, Exim
27156 computes the rate and checks the limit as normal, but it does not update the
27157 saved data. This means that, in relevant ACLs, it is possible to lookup the
27158 existence of a specified (or auto-generated) ratelimit key without incrementing
27159 the ratelimit counter for that key. In order for this to be useful, another ACL
27160 entry must set the rate for the same key (otherwise it will always be zero).
27164 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / per_cmd / noupdate
27165 log_message = RATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27166 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27169 &'... some other logic and tests...'&
27173 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / per_cmd
27174 condition = ${if le{$sender_rate}{$sender_rate_limit}}
27175 logwrite = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27176 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27178 In this example, the rate is tested and used to deny access (when it is too
27179 high) in the connect ACL, but the actual computation of the remembered rate
27180 happens later, on a per-command basis, in another ACL.
27184 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
27185 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
27186 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
27187 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
27188 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
27189 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
27190 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
27191 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
27192 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
27194 verify = sender/callout
27195 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
27197 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
27198 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
27199 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
27200 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
27201 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
27202 The available options are as follows:
27205 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
27206 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
27207 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
27209 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
27210 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
27211 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
27212 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
27214 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
27215 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
27217 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
27218 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
27219 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
27220 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
27223 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
27224 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
27225 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
27226 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27227 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
27228 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
27231 warn !verify = sender
27232 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
27234 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
27235 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
27236 verification failure.
27238 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
27239 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
27242 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
27243 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
27245 &%route%&: Routing failed.
27247 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
27248 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
27249 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
27251 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
27253 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
27256 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
27257 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
27262 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
27263 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
27264 .cindex "callout" "verification"
27265 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
27266 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
27267 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
27268 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
27269 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
27270 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
27271 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
27272 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
27273 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
27276 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
27277 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
27278 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
27279 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
27280 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
27281 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
27283 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
27284 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
27285 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
27286 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
27287 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
27289 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
27290 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
27291 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
27292 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
27293 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
27294 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
27295 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
27296 supplies a host list.
27298 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
27299 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
27300 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
27301 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
27302 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
27303 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
27304 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
27306 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
27307 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
27308 following SMTP commands are sent:
27310 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
27312 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
27315 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
27318 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
27319 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
27320 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
27321 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
27322 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
27323 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
27325 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
27326 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
27327 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
27328 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
27329 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
27331 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27332 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
27333 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
27334 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
27335 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
27340 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
27341 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
27342 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
27343 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
27345 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
27347 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
27348 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
27349 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
27353 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
27354 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
27355 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
27358 verify = sender/callout=5s
27360 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
27361 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
27362 the &%connect%& parameter.
27365 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27366 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
27367 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
27368 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
27370 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
27372 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
27374 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
27375 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
27376 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
27377 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
27378 updated in this circumstance.
27380 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
27381 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
27382 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
27383 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
27384 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
27385 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
27388 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27389 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
27390 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
27391 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
27392 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
27393 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
27394 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
27395 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
27396 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
27397 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
27399 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
27401 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
27404 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27405 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
27406 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
27409 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
27411 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
27412 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
27413 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
27414 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
27415 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
27418 .vitem &*no_cache*&
27419 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
27420 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
27421 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
27423 .vitem &*postmaster*&
27424 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
27425 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
27426 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
27427 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
27428 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
27429 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
27430 made, until the cache record expires.
27432 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27433 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
27434 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
27437 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
27439 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
27440 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
27442 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
27444 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
27445 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
27446 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
27447 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
27451 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
27452 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
27453 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
27454 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
27455 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
27457 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
27459 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
27460 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
27461 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
27462 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
27463 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
27465 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
27466 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
27467 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27469 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
27471 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
27472 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
27473 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
27474 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
27475 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
27477 .vitem &*use_sender*&
27478 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27480 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
27482 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
27483 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
27484 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
27485 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
27486 usefulness of callout caching.
27489 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
27490 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
27491 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
27492 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
27493 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
27494 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
27495 these circumstances.
27497 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
27498 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
27499 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
27500 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
27501 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
27502 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
27503 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
27505 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
27506 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
27507 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
27508 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
27513 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
27514 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
27515 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
27516 .cindex "caching" "callout"
27517 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
27518 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
27519 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
27520 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
27521 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
27522 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
27524 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
27525 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
27528 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
27529 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
27530 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
27532 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
27533 commands up to and including
27537 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
27538 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
27539 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
27540 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
27541 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
27542 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
27543 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
27545 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
27546 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
27547 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
27548 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
27549 will eventually be noticed.
27551 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
27552 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
27553 behaviour will be the same.
27557 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
27558 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
27559 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
27560 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
27561 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
27562 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
27565 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
27567 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
27568 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
27569 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
27570 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
27571 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
27572 550 Sender verification failed
27574 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
27575 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
27576 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
27577 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
27580 verify = sender/no_details
27583 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
27584 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
27585 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
27586 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
27587 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
27588 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
27589 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
27592 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
27593 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
27594 verification also fails.
27596 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
27597 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
27600 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
27601 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
27602 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
27605 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
27607 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
27608 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
27609 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
27610 verification to succeed.
27612 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
27613 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
27614 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
27615 option. For example:
27617 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
27619 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
27620 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
27622 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
27623 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
27624 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
27625 address and a report is output for each of them.
27629 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
27630 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
27631 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
27632 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
27633 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
27634 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
27635 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
27639 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
27640 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
27641 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
27642 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
27643 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
27644 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
27646 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
27647 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
27648 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
27649 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
27652 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
27654 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
27656 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
27657 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
27659 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
27660 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
27663 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
27664 use for the DNS query. The default is:
27666 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
27668 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
27669 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
27670 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
27671 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
27674 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
27676 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
27677 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
27678 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
27680 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
27681 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
27682 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
27683 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
27684 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
27685 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
27686 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
27687 of legitimate HELO domains.
27689 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
27690 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
27691 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
27692 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
27695 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
27697 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
27698 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
27699 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
27704 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
27705 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
27706 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
27707 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
27708 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
27709 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
27710 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
27711 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
27713 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
27714 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
27715 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
27716 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
27717 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
27718 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
27719 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
27721 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
27722 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
27725 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
27726 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
27729 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
27730 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
27733 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
27734 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
27736 recipients = +batv_senders
27738 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
27739 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
27741 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
27742 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
27743 !condition = $prvscheck_result
27745 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
27746 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
27747 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
27748 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
27749 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
27751 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
27752 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
27753 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
27754 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
27755 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
27756 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
27757 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
27759 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
27760 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
27761 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
27762 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
27766 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
27768 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
27769 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
27770 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
27773 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
27776 external_smtp_batv:
27778 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
27779 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
27780 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
27781 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
27784 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
27788 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
27789 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
27790 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
27791 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
27792 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
27793 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
27794 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
27795 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
27796 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
27797 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
27799 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
27800 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
27801 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
27802 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
27803 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
27804 same host is fulfilling both functions,
27806 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
27808 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
27809 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
27810 system to arbitrary domains.
27813 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
27814 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
27815 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
27816 example, suppose you want to do the following:
27819 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
27820 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
27821 &'my.dom2.example'&.
27823 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
27824 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
27826 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
27827 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
27831 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
27833 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
27834 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
27835 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
27837 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
27841 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
27842 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
27844 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
27845 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
27846 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
27847 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
27848 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
27849 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
27850 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27854 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
27855 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
27856 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
27857 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
27858 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27860 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
27861 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
27862 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
27863 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
27864 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
27865 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
27866 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
27871 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27872 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27874 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
27875 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
27876 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
27877 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
27878 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
27879 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
27882 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
27883 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
27884 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
27885 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
27886 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
27888 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
27889 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
27890 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
27893 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
27894 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
27896 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
27897 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
27898 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
27900 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
27901 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
27903 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
27906 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
27909 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
27910 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
27911 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
27913 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
27914 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
27915 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
27916 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
27917 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
27918 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
27920 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
27921 temporarily created in a file called:
27923 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
27925 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
27926 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
27927 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
27928 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
27929 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
27931 control = no_mbox_unspool
27933 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
27934 same directory by default.
27938 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
27939 .cindex "virus scanning"
27940 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
27941 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
27942 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
27943 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
27944 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
27945 in memory and thus are much faster.
27947 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
27948 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
27949 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
27950 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
27952 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
27954 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
27956 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
27958 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
27959 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
27962 .vitem &%aveserver%&
27963 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
27964 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
27965 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
27966 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
27969 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
27973 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
27974 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
27975 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
27976 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
27977 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
27978 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
27979 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
27981 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
27982 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
27983 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
27985 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
27986 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
27987 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
27988 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
27989 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
27990 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
27991 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
27992 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
27993 contributing the code for this scanner.
27996 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
27997 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
27998 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
27999 type takes 3 mandatory options:
28002 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
28003 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
28006 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
28007 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
28008 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
28009 the &"trigger"& expression.
28012 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
28013 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
28014 &"name"& expression.
28017 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
28019 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
28021 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
28022 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
28023 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
28024 configuration setting:
28026 av_scanner = cmdline:\
28027 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
28028 found in file:'(.+)'
28031 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
28032 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
28033 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
28034 separated by white space, as in these examples:
28036 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
28037 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
28039 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
28040 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
28043 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
28044 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
28045 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
28047 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
28049 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
28050 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
28052 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
28053 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
28054 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
28055 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
28056 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
28059 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
28061 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
28064 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
28065 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
28066 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
28067 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
28068 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
28069 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
28070 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
28072 av_scanner = mksd:2
28074 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
28077 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
28078 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
28079 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
28080 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
28081 client communication. For example:
28083 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
28085 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
28089 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
28090 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
28093 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
28094 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
28095 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
28096 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
28097 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
28098 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
28101 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
28102 use. It can then be one of
28105 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
28106 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
28109 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
28110 the condition fails immediately.
28112 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
28113 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
28114 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
28117 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
28118 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
28119 causes the ACL to defer.
28121 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
28122 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
28123 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
28124 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
28127 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
28128 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
28129 &%malware%& condition.
28131 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
28132 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
28134 Here is a very simple scanning example:
28136 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28140 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
28142 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28144 malware = */defer_ok
28146 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
28147 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
28149 av_scanner = $acl_m0
28151 in the main Exim configuration.
28153 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28154 set acl_m0 = sophie
28157 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28158 set acl_m0 = aveserver
28163 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
28164 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
28165 .cindex "spam scanning"
28166 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
28167 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
28168 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
28169 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
28170 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
28172 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
28174 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
28175 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
28178 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
28179 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
28180 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
28181 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
28182 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
28184 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
28186 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
28187 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
28188 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
28191 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
28193 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
28194 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
28195 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
28196 option, separated with colons:
28198 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
28199 192.168.2.11 783 : \
28202 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
28203 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
28204 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
28207 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
28208 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
28210 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
28211 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
28212 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
28215 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
28216 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
28218 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28221 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
28222 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
28223 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
28224 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
28225 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
28227 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
28228 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
28229 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
28230 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
28231 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
28234 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
28235 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
28236 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
28239 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
28240 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
28241 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
28244 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28245 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
28249 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
28250 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
28251 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
28252 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
28254 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
28255 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
28256 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
28257 available for use at delivery time.
28260 .vitem &$spam_score$&
28261 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
28262 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
28264 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
28265 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
28266 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
28267 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
28268 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
28271 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
28272 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
28273 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
28274 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
28275 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
28277 .vitem &$spam_report$&
28278 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
28279 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
28282 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
28283 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
28284 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
28286 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
28287 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
28288 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
28289 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
28290 spam condition, like this:
28292 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28293 spam = joe/defer_ok
28295 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
28297 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
28300 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
28301 warn spam = nobody:true
28302 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
28303 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
28305 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
28306 # is over threshold
28308 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
28310 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
28311 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
28313 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
28318 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
28319 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
28320 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28321 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
28322 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
28323 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
28324 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
28325 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
28326 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
28327 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
28330 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
28331 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
28332 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
28333 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
28334 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
28335 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
28336 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
28338 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
28339 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
28340 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
28341 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
28342 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
28344 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
28345 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
28346 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
28347 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
28348 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
28351 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
28353 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
28357 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
28359 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
28360 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
28361 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
28362 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
28364 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
28365 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
28366 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
28367 the full path and file name.
28369 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
28370 filename, and the default path is then used.
28372 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
28373 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
28374 a file with its original, proposed filename using
28376 decode = $mime_filename
28378 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
28379 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
28380 automatically unlinked.
28382 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
28383 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
28384 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
28385 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
28386 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
28388 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
28389 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
28390 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
28392 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
28393 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
28394 available in the MIME ACL:
28397 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
28398 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
28399 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
28400 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
28401 contains the empty string.
28403 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
28404 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
28405 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
28411 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
28412 case-insensitively.
28414 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
28415 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
28416 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
28417 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
28418 only used for display purposes.
28420 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
28421 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
28422 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
28424 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
28425 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
28426 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
28428 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
28429 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28430 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
28431 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
28432 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
28434 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
28435 This variable contains the normalized content of the
28436 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
28437 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
28439 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
28440 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
28441 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
28442 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
28446 application/octet-stream
28450 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
28453 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
28454 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28455 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
28456 containing the decoded data.
28461 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
28462 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
28463 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
28464 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
28465 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
28466 found, this variable contains the empty string.
28468 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
28469 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
28470 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
28471 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
28473 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
28474 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
28478 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
28481 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
28482 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
28485 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
28486 and the rest are attachments.
28489 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
28492 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
28493 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
28494 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
28496 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
28497 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
28498 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
28499 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
28501 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
28502 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
28503 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
28504 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
28505 want to carry out specific actions on them.
28507 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
28508 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
28509 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
28510 decoding is fully recursive.
28512 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
28513 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
28514 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
28515 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
28516 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
28517 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
28518 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
28523 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
28524 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
28525 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
28526 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
28527 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
28529 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
28530 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
28531 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
28532 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
28533 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
28535 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
28536 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
28537 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
28538 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
28539 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
28540 32K characters are checked.
28542 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
28543 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
28544 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
28545 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
28546 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
28548 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
28549 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
28551 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
28552 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
28553 matching regular expression.
28555 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
28561 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
28562 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
28563 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28564 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
28565 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
28566 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
28567 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
28568 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
28569 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
28570 use the &%demime%& condition.
28572 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
28573 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
28574 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
28575 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
28576 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
28577 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
28579 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
28580 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
28583 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
28584 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
28586 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
28587 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
28588 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
28589 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
28591 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
28592 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
28593 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
28595 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
28598 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
28599 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
28600 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
28601 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
28602 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
28603 zero, no error occurred.
28605 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
28606 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
28607 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
28608 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
28612 .vitem &$found_extension$&
28613 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
28614 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
28615 extension it found.
28618 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
28619 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
28621 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
28622 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
28623 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
28626 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
28627 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
28629 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
28631 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
28632 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
28633 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
28634 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
28636 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
28637 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
28638 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
28647 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28648 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28650 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
28651 "Local scan function"
28652 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
28653 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
28654 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
28655 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
28656 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
28658 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
28659 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
28660 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
28661 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
28662 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
28664 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
28665 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
28666 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
28667 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
28669 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
28670 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
28671 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
28672 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
28674 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
28675 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
28676 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
28677 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
28678 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
28679 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
28680 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
28681 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
28682 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
28686 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
28687 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
28688 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
28689 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
28690 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
28691 directory, so you might set
28693 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
28695 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
28696 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
28697 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
28698 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
28699 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
28700 _src/local_scan.c_.
28702 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
28703 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
28705 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28707 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
28712 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
28713 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
28714 You must include this line near the start of your code:
28716 #include "local_scan.h"
28718 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
28719 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
28720 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
28721 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
28722 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
28723 strings and pointers to character strings:
28725 #define CS (char *)
28726 #define CCS (const char *)
28727 #define CSS (char **)
28728 #define US (unsigned char *)
28729 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
28730 #define USS (unsigned char **)
28732 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
28734 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
28736 The arguments are as follows:
28739 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
28740 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
28741 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
28743 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
28744 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
28745 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
28746 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
28747 case this changes in some future version.
28749 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
28750 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
28753 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
28756 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
28757 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
28758 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
28759 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
28760 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
28761 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
28763 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
28764 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28765 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
28767 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
28768 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28769 queued without immediate delivery.
28771 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
28772 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
28773 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
28774 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
28775 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
28778 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
28779 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
28780 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
28783 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28784 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
28785 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
28786 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
28787 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
28788 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
28789 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28791 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28792 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
28793 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28796 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
28797 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
28798 &%-oe%& command line options.
28802 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
28803 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
28804 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
28805 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
28806 want to do this, you must have the line
28808 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28810 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
28811 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
28812 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
28815 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
28816 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
28817 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
28818 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
28819 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
28820 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
28822 static int my_integer_option = 42;
28823 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
28825 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
28826 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
28827 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
28830 int local_scan_options_count =
28831 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
28833 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
28834 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
28838 my_string = some string of text...
28840 The available types of option data are as follows:
28843 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
28844 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
28845 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
28846 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
28847 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
28848 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
28851 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
28852 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
28853 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
28854 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
28857 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
28858 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
28861 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
28862 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
28863 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
28864 printed with the suffix K or M.
28866 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
28867 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
28868 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
28869 always output in octal.
28871 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
28872 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
28873 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
28875 .vitem &*opt_time*&
28876 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
28877 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
28880 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
28881 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
28885 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
28886 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
28887 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
28888 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
28889 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
28890 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
28891 C variables are as follows:
28894 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
28895 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
28897 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
28898 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
28900 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
28901 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
28902 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
28903 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
28906 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
28907 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
28908 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
28911 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
28912 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
28916 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
28917 selected, you should use code like this:
28919 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
28920 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
28922 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
28923 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
28924 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
28926 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
28927 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
28930 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
28931 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
28933 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
28934 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
28936 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
28937 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
28938 &%-bh%& command line option.
28940 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
28941 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
28942 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
28944 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
28945 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
28946 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
28947 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
28949 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
28950 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
28951 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
28953 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
28954 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
28956 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
28957 The number of accepted recipients.
28959 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
28960 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
28961 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
28962 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
28963 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
28964 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
28965 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
28966 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
28967 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
28968 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
28969 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
28970 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
28972 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
28973 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
28975 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
28976 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
28977 locally-submitted messages.
28979 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
28980 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
28981 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
28983 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
28984 The name of the sending host, if known.
28986 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
28987 The port on the sending host.
28989 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
28990 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
28992 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
28993 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
28995 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
28996 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
28997 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
29001 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
29002 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
29003 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
29004 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
29009 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
29010 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
29012 .vitem &*int&~type*&
29013 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
29014 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
29015 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
29016 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
29017 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
29018 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
29020 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
29021 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
29024 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
29025 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
29026 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
29031 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
29032 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
29035 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
29036 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
29038 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
29039 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
29040 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
29041 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
29043 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
29044 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
29045 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
29046 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
29047 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
29048 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
29049 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
29050 is NULL for all recipients.
29055 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
29056 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
29057 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
29058 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
29062 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
29063 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
29065 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
29066 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
29067 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
29068 for the process in &%newumask%&.
29070 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
29071 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
29072 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
29073 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
29074 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
29076 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
29078 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
29079 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
29080 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
29081 return value is as follows:
29086 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
29092 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
29098 The process timed out.
29102 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
29105 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
29106 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
29107 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
29108 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
29109 forks a subprocess that is running
29111 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
29113 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
29114 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
29115 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
29116 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
29118 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
29119 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
29120 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
29121 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
29124 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
29125 *sender_authentication)*&
29126 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
29129 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
29131 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
29134 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29135 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
29136 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
29137 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
29138 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
29140 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
29141 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
29144 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
29145 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
29146 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
29147 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
29148 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
29149 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
29150 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
29151 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
29153 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
29154 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
29155 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
29156 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
29157 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
29158 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
29160 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29161 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
29162 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
29163 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
29165 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
29166 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
29167 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
29168 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
29169 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
29170 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
29171 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
29172 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
29173 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
29174 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
29176 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
29177 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
29179 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
29180 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
29183 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
29184 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
29185 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
29186 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
29187 match the specification, the function does nothing.
29190 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29191 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
29192 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
29193 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
29194 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
29195 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
29197 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
29199 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
29200 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
29201 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
29202 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
29203 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
29206 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
29207 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
29208 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
29209 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
29210 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
29211 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
29212 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
29213 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
29215 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
29216 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
29217 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
29219 &`OK `& match succeeded
29220 &`FAIL `& match failed
29221 &`DEFER `& match deferred
29223 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
29224 inability to contact a database.
29226 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29228 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
29229 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
29230 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29232 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29234 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
29235 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
29236 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29238 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
29240 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
29243 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
29245 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
29246 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
29247 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
29248 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
29249 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
29250 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
29253 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
29255 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
29256 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
29257 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
29258 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
29259 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
29260 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
29263 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
29264 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
29265 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
29266 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
29268 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
29269 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
29270 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
29271 value afterwards. For example:
29273 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
29274 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
29275 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
29278 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
29279 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
29280 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
29281 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
29288 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
29289 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
29290 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
29291 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
29292 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
29293 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
29294 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
29295 binary string is returned with an error message.
29297 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
29298 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
29299 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
29301 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
29302 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
29303 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
29304 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
29305 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
29307 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
29308 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
29309 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
29311 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
29312 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
29313 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
29314 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
29318 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
29319 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
29322 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29323 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
29324 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
29325 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
29326 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
29327 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
29328 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
29329 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
29332 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
29333 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
29335 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
29336 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
29337 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
29338 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
29339 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
29340 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
29341 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
29343 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
29344 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
29346 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
29347 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
29348 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
29349 multiple output lines.
29351 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
29352 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
29353 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
29354 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
29355 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
29356 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
29357 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
29360 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
29361 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
29362 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
29363 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29365 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
29366 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
29367 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29369 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
29372 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
29375 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
29376 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
29377 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
29378 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
29379 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
29380 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
29386 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
29387 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
29388 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
29389 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
29390 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
29391 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
29392 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
29395 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
29396 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
29397 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
29398 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
29400 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
29401 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
29403 store_pool = POOL_PERM
29405 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
29406 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
29407 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
29408 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
29410 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
29411 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
29412 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
29413 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
29420 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29421 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29423 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
29424 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
29425 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
29426 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
29427 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
29428 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
29429 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
29430 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
29432 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
29433 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
29434 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
29435 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
29436 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
29438 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
29439 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
29440 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
29441 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
29442 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
29443 prevent it happening on retries.
29445 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29446 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29447 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
29448 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
29449 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
29450 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
29451 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
29452 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
29455 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
29456 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
29457 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
29458 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
29459 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
29460 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
29461 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
29463 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
29464 system_filter_user = exim
29466 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
29467 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
29468 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
29469 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
29470 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
29471 by the &%reply%& command.
29474 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
29475 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
29476 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
29477 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
29479 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
29480 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
29484 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
29485 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
29486 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
29487 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
29488 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
29489 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
29492 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
29493 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
29494 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
29495 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
29496 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
29497 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
29498 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
29500 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
29501 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
29502 succeed, it will not be tried again.
29503 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
29504 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
29506 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
29507 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
29508 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
29509 to which users' filter files can refer.
29513 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
29514 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
29515 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
29516 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
29517 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
29521 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
29522 .cindex "freezing messages"
29523 .cindex "message" "freezing"
29524 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
29525 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
29526 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
29527 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
29528 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
29529 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
29530 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
29531 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
29532 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
29534 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
29536 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
29538 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
29539 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
29540 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
29541 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
29542 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
29545 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
29546 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
29547 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
29548 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
29550 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
29551 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
29552 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
29553 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
29554 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
29555 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
29556 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
29557 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
29558 message. For example:
29560 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
29561 because it contains attachments that we are \
29562 not prepared to receive."
29565 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
29566 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
29567 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
29568 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
29569 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
29570 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
29573 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
29574 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
29576 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
29577 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
29578 generated by the filter.
29580 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
29582 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
29583 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
29589 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
29590 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
29595 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
29596 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
29597 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
29598 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
29599 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
29601 headers add <string>
29602 headers remove <string>
29604 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
29605 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
29606 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
29607 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
29608 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
29610 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
29611 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
29612 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
29615 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
29616 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
29619 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
29620 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
29621 space after input continuations is ignored.
29623 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
29624 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
29625 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
29626 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
29627 header with the same name, they are all removed.
29629 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
29630 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
29631 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
29632 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
29633 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
29634 used for all recipients of the message.
29636 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
29637 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
29638 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
29639 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
29640 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
29641 until the message is actually being written (see section
29642 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
29644 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
29645 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
29646 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
29647 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
29648 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
29649 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
29650 modified more than once.
29652 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
29653 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
29656 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
29657 headers remove "Subject"
29658 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
29659 headers remove "Old-Subject"
29664 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
29665 .cindex "envelope sender"
29666 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
29668 errors_to <some address>
29670 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
29671 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
29672 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
29675 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
29677 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
29678 address if its delivery failed.
29682 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
29683 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29684 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29685 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
29686 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
29687 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
29688 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
29689 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
29690 which implements such a filter:
29695 domains = +local_domains
29696 file = /central/filters/$local_part
29701 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
29702 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
29703 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
29704 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
29706 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
29707 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
29708 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
29709 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
29711 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
29712 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
29713 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
29720 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29721 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29723 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
29724 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
29725 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
29726 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
29727 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
29728 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
29729 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
29730 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
29732 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
29733 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
29734 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
29735 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
29736 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
29738 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
29739 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
29740 loopback interface specially in any way.
29742 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
29743 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
29748 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
29749 .cindex "message" "submission"
29750 .cindex "submission mode"
29751 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
29752 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
29753 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
29754 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
29756 control = submission
29758 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
29759 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
29760 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
29761 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
29762 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
29763 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
29765 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
29766 control = submission
29768 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
29769 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
29770 is used to separate options. For example:
29772 control = submission/sender_retain
29774 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
29775 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
29776 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
29777 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
29778 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
29779 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
29780 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
29782 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
29783 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
29786 control = submission/domain=some.domain
29788 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
29789 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
29790 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
29791 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
29793 accept authenticated = *
29794 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
29795 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
29796 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
29798 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
29799 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
29800 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
29802 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
29804 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
29807 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
29809 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
29810 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
29811 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
29812 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
29814 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
29815 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
29816 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
29817 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
29818 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
29819 spoof another's address.
29821 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
29822 .cindex "line endings"
29823 .cindex "carriage return"
29825 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
29826 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
29827 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
29828 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
29829 use CRLF or just CR.
29831 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
29832 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
29833 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
29834 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
29835 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
29836 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
29837 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
29838 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
29842 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
29844 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
29847 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
29848 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
29851 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
29852 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
29853 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
29854 people trying to play silly games.
29856 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
29857 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
29865 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
29866 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
29867 .cindex "address" "qualification"
29868 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
29869 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
29870 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
29871 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
29872 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
29874 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
29875 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
29876 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
29877 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
29878 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
29880 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
29881 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
29882 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
29883 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
29884 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
29885 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
29886 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
29887 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
29892 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
29893 .cindex "&""From""& line"
29894 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
29895 .cindex "sender" "address"
29896 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
29897 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
29898 .cindex "envelope sender"
29899 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29900 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
29901 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
29902 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
29904 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
29905 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
29907 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
29908 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
29909 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
29910 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
29911 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
29912 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
29913 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
29914 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
29915 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
29917 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
29918 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
29919 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
29920 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
29921 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
29922 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
29923 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
29925 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
29926 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
29927 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
29929 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
29930 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
29931 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
29932 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
29936 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
29937 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
29938 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
29939 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
29940 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
29941 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
29942 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
29945 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
29946 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
29949 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
29950 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
29954 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
29955 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
29957 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
29958 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
29959 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
29961 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
29964 For a locally-submitted message,
29965 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
29966 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
29967 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
29968 included in log lines in this case.
29970 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
29971 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
29977 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
29978 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
29979 includes the header line:
29981 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
29984 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
29985 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
29986 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
29987 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
29988 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
29989 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
29992 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
29993 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
29994 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
29995 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
29996 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
29998 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
29999 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
30000 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
30001 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
30002 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
30003 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
30004 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
30005 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
30009 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
30010 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
30011 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
30012 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
30013 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
30014 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
30015 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
30016 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
30020 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
30021 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
30022 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
30023 .cindex "message" "submission"
30024 .cindex "submission mode"
30025 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
30026 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
30029 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
30030 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
30032 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
30033 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
30035 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30036 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
30037 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
30039 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
30040 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
30042 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
30043 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
30047 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
30049 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
30050 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
30051 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
30052 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
30053 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
30054 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
30055 &%qualify_domain%&.
30057 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
30058 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
30059 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
30060 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
30063 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
30064 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
30065 .cindex "message" "submission"
30066 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
30067 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
30068 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
30069 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
30070 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
30071 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
30072 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
30073 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
30074 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
30075 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
30078 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
30079 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
30080 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
30081 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
30082 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
30084 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
30085 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
30086 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
30087 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
30089 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
30090 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
30091 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
30094 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
30095 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
30096 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
30097 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
30098 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
30099 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
30100 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
30101 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
30102 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
30103 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
30104 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
30108 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
30109 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
30110 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
30111 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
30112 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
30113 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
30114 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
30115 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
30119 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
30120 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
30121 .cindex "message" "submission"
30122 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
30123 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
30124 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
30125 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30128 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
30129 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30130 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
30131 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
30132 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
30133 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
30134 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
30135 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
30136 line is added to the message.
30138 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
30139 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
30140 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
30141 options true at the same time.
30143 .cindex "submission mode"
30144 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
30145 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
30146 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
30147 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
30149 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
30150 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
30151 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
30152 created as follows:
30155 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30156 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
30157 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
30159 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
30160 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
30162 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
30163 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
30166 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
30167 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
30168 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
30169 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
30171 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
30172 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
30173 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
30174 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
30178 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
30179 "SECTheadersaddrem"
30180 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
30181 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
30182 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
30183 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
30184 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
30185 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
30186 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
30188 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
30189 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
30190 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
30191 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
30192 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
30193 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
30195 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
30196 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
30197 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
30199 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
30200 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
30201 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
30203 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
30204 X-added-second: another added header line
30206 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
30208 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
30209 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
30210 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
30211 not part of the names. For example:
30213 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
30215 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
30216 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
30217 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
30218 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
30219 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
30221 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
30222 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
30223 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
30224 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
30226 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
30227 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
30228 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
30231 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
30232 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
30233 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
30234 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
30235 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
30236 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
30237 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
30239 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
30240 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
30241 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
30242 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
30244 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
30245 the following consequences:
30248 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
30249 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
30250 to it, at all times.
30252 Header lines that are added by a router's
30253 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
30254 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
30256 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
30257 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
30259 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
30260 a later router or by a transport.
30262 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
30263 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
30265 headers_remove = subject
30266 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
30270 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
30271 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
30277 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
30278 .cindex "address" "constructed"
30279 .cindex "constructed address"
30280 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
30283 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
30287 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
30289 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
30290 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
30291 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
30292 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
30293 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
30294 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
30295 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
30296 there is no password file entry.
30299 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
30300 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
30301 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
30302 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
30303 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
30304 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
30305 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
30306 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
30310 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
30311 .cindex "case of local parts"
30312 .cindex "local part" "case of"
30313 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
30314 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
30315 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
30316 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
30317 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
30318 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
30321 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
30322 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
30323 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
30324 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
30325 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
30329 domains = +local_domains
30330 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
30331 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
30334 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
30335 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
30336 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
30337 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
30338 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
30342 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
30343 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
30344 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
30345 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
30346 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
30347 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
30348 empty components for compatibility.
30352 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
30353 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
30354 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
30355 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
30356 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
30357 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
30359 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
30360 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
30361 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
30362 example, a header such as
30366 might get rewritten as
30368 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
30370 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
30371 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
30374 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
30375 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
30376 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
30377 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
30378 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
30379 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
30380 .ecindex IIDmesproc
30384 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30385 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30387 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
30388 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
30389 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
30390 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
30391 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
30392 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
30393 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
30396 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
30398 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
30400 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
30403 For mail delivery, the following are available:
30406 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
30408 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
30411 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
30414 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
30415 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
30418 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
30419 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
30420 used to contain the envelope information.
30424 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
30425 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
30426 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
30427 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
30428 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
30431 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30432 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
30433 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
30434 processing is the same in both cases.
30436 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
30437 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
30438 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
30439 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
30440 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
30441 .cindex "transport" "filter"
30442 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
30443 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
30446 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
30447 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
30448 required for the transaction.
30450 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
30451 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
30452 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
30454 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
30455 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
30456 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
30458 .cindex "carriage return"
30460 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30461 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
30462 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30465 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
30466 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
30467 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
30468 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
30469 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
30470 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
30471 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
30472 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
30473 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
30475 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
30476 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
30477 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
30478 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
30480 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
30481 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
30482 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
30483 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
30485 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
30486 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
30487 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
30488 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
30489 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
30490 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
30491 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
30492 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
30493 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
30494 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
30496 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
30497 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
30499 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
30500 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
30501 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
30502 square bracket of the IP address.
30507 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
30508 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
30509 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
30510 .cindex "host" "error"
30511 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
30512 message errors, and recipient errors.
30515 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
30516 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
30517 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
30520 Connection refused or timed out,
30522 Any error response code on connection,
30524 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
30526 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
30528 I/O errors at any time,
30530 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
30531 the &"."& at the end of the data.
30534 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
30535 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
30536 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
30537 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
30538 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
30539 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
30540 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
30541 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
30543 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
30544 .cindex "message" "error"
30545 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
30546 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
30547 message errors are:
30550 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
30553 Timeout after MAIL,
30555 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
30556 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
30557 connection at any other time.
30560 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
30561 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
30562 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
30563 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
30564 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
30565 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
30566 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
30567 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
30568 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
30569 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
30571 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
30572 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
30573 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
30576 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
30577 .cindex "recipient" "error"
30578 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
30579 recipient errors are:
30582 Any error response to RCPT,
30584 Timeout after RCPT.
30587 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
30588 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
30589 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
30590 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
30591 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
30592 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
30593 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
30594 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
30595 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
30596 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
30597 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
30598 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
30599 the retry clock is reset.
30601 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
30602 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
30603 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
30604 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
30605 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
30606 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
30607 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
30608 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
30609 recipient's retry time.
30612 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
30613 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
30614 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
30615 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
30616 until the next delivery attempt.
30618 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
30619 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
30620 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
30621 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
30622 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
30625 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
30626 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
30627 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
30628 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
30629 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
30630 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
30631 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
30633 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
30634 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
30635 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
30636 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
30637 then to be treated as a host error.
30639 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
30640 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
30641 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
30642 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
30643 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
30648 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
30649 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
30650 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
30653 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
30654 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
30655 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
30657 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
30659 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
30660 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
30661 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
30662 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
30663 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
30664 stream and exits with an error code.
30666 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
30667 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
30668 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
30669 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
30671 .cindex "carriage return"
30673 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30674 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
30675 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30677 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
30678 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
30679 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
30681 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
30682 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
30683 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
30684 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
30685 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
30686 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
30687 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
30688 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
30690 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30691 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
30692 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
30693 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
30694 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
30695 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
30696 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
30697 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
30698 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
30700 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
30701 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
30702 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
30704 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
30705 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
30706 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
30707 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
30708 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
30710 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
30711 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
30712 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
30713 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
30714 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
30715 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
30716 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
30718 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
30719 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
30720 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
30721 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
30722 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
30724 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
30725 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
30726 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
30727 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
30728 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
30729 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
30730 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
30731 a delivery process.
30733 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
30734 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
30735 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
30736 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
30737 however, available with &'inetd'&.
30739 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
30740 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
30741 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
30742 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
30744 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
30745 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
30746 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
30750 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
30751 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
30752 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
30753 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
30754 the error response to the last command. The default value for
30755 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
30756 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
30757 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
30760 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
30761 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
30762 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
30763 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
30764 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
30765 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
30766 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
30767 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
30768 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
30769 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
30770 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
30774 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
30775 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
30776 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
30777 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
30778 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
30779 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
30780 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
30781 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
30783 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
30784 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
30785 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
30786 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
30787 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
30790 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
30791 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
30792 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
30794 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
30795 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
30796 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
30797 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
30798 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
30803 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
30804 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
30805 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
30806 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
30807 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30809 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
30810 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
30811 called with the &%-bv%& option.
30813 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
30814 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
30815 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
30816 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
30817 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
30818 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
30819 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
30824 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
30825 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
30826 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
30827 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
30828 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
30829 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
30830 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30832 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
30833 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
30834 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
30835 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
30836 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
30837 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
30838 argument. For example,
30846 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
30847 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
30848 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
30849 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
30850 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
30852 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
30853 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
30854 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
30855 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
30856 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
30857 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
30858 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
30859 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
30861 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
30862 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
30863 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
30864 whatever the form of its argument. For
30867 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
30868 $sender_host_address
30870 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30871 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
30872 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
30873 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
30874 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
30875 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
30876 for it to change them before running the command.
30880 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
30881 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
30882 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
30883 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
30884 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
30885 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
30886 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
30887 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
30888 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
30889 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
30890 runs for RCPT commands:
30894 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
30898 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
30899 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
30900 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
30901 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
30902 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
30903 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
30904 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
30905 envelope along with the message.
30907 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
30908 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
30909 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
30910 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
30911 can be used to specify it.
30913 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
30914 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
30915 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
30916 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
30917 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
30920 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
30921 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
30922 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
30927 driver = manualroute
30928 transport = smtp_appendfile
30929 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
30933 driver = appendfile
30934 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
30939 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
30940 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
30941 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
30945 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
30946 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
30947 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
30948 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
30949 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
30950 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
30951 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
30952 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
30953 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
30954 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
30956 No policy checking is done for BSMTP input. That is, no ACL is run at anytime.
30957 In this respect it is like non-SMTP local input.
30959 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
30960 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
30961 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
30962 make some use of automatically, for example:
30964 554 Unexpected end of file
30965 Transaction started in line 10
30966 Error detected in line 14
30968 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
30971 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
30972 The error message was:
30974 501 '>' missing at end of address
30976 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
30977 The error was detected in line 12.
30978 The SMTP command at fault was:
30980 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
30982 1 previous message was successfully processed.
30983 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
30985 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
30986 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
30988 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
30989 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
30993 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30994 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30996 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
30997 "Customizing messages"
30998 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
30999 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
31000 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
31001 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
31002 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
31004 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
31005 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
31006 option. Exim also adds the line
31008 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
31010 to all warning and bounce messages,
31013 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
31014 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
31015 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
31016 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
31017 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
31018 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
31019 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
31021 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
31022 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
31023 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
31024 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
31025 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
31028 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
31029 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
31030 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
31031 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
31032 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
31033 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
31034 option, rounded to a whole number.
31036 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
31039 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
31040 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
31042 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
31043 failing addresses with their error messages.
31045 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
31046 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
31048 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
31049 as part of the error report.
31051 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
31052 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
31054 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
31057 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
31058 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
31059 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
31061 Subject: Mail delivery failed
31062 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
31063 {: returning message to sender}}
31065 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
31067 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
31068 {that you sent }{sent by
31072 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
31073 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
31075 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
31077 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
31080 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
31082 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
31085 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
31086 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
31087 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
31088 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
31089 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
31093 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
31094 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
31096 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
31097 the delayed addresses.
31099 The third item then ends the message.
31102 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
31103 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
31105 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
31106 $warn_message_delay
31108 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
31110 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
31111 {that you sent }{sent by
31115 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
31116 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
31118 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
31119 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
31120 The date of the message is: $h_date
31122 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
31124 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
31125 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
31126 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
31127 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
31128 the message will be returned to you.
31130 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
31131 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
31132 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
31133 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
31134 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
31135 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
31136 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
31137 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
31143 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31144 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31146 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
31147 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
31148 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
31152 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
31153 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
31154 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
31155 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
31156 routing explicitly:
31158 send_to_smart_host:
31159 driver = manualroute
31160 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
31161 transport = remote_smtp
31163 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
31164 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
31165 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
31166 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
31167 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
31172 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
31173 .cindex "mailing lists"
31174 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
31175 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
31176 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
31178 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
31179 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
31180 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
31181 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
31185 domains = lists.example
31186 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31189 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31192 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
31193 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
31194 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
31195 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
31197 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
31198 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
31201 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
31202 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
31203 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
31204 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
31205 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
31207 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
31208 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
31209 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
31210 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
31211 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
31212 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
31213 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
31214 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
31215 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
31219 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
31220 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
31221 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
31222 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
31223 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
31224 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
31225 addresses are not rigorously checked.
31227 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
31228 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
31229 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
31230 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
31231 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
31235 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
31236 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
31237 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
31238 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
31239 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
31240 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
31241 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
31242 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
31243 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
31244 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
31246 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
31247 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
31248 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
31249 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
31250 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
31251 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
31252 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
31253 pre-existing messages.
31255 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
31256 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
31257 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
31258 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
31259 one level of expansion anyway.
31263 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
31264 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
31265 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
31266 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
31267 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
31268 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
31270 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
31271 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
31275 domains = lists.example
31276 local_part_suffix = -request
31277 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
31282 domains = lists.example
31283 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
31284 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
31285 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31288 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31293 domains = lists.example
31295 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
31297 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
31298 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
31299 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
31302 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
31303 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
31304 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
31305 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
31306 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
31307 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
31308 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
31309 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
31310 &"unrouteable address"& error.
31312 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
31313 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
31314 the address, giving a suitable error message.
31319 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
31321 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
31322 .cindex "envelope sender"
31323 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
31324 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
31325 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
31326 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
31327 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
31328 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
31330 .oindex &%errors_to%&
31331 .oindex &%return_path%&
31332 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
31333 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
31334 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
31335 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
31336 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
31337 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
31338 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
31344 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31345 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31347 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
31348 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
31349 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
31350 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
31351 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
31352 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
31353 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
31356 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
31358 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31359 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
31360 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
31361 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
31362 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
31363 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
31365 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
31366 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
31367 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
31368 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
31372 domains = ! +local_domains
31374 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31375 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
31378 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
31379 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
31380 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
31381 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
31384 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
31385 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
31386 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
31387 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
31388 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
31392 domains = ! +local_domains
31393 transport = remote_smtp
31395 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
31396 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31399 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
31400 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
31401 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
31402 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
31405 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
31406 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
31407 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
31408 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
31409 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
31410 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
31418 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
31419 .cindex "virtual domains"
31420 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
31421 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
31425 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
31426 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
31427 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
31429 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
31430 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
31431 have login accounts on that host.
31434 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
31435 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
31436 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
31437 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
31438 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
31439 to a router of this form:
31443 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
31444 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
31447 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
31448 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
31449 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
31450 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
31451 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
31452 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
31454 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
31455 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
31456 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
31457 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
31459 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
31460 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
31461 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
31465 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
31466 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
31467 transport = my_mailboxes
31469 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
31470 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
31471 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
31472 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
31473 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
31477 driver = appendfile
31478 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
31481 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
31482 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
31484 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
31485 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
31486 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
31487 information about the domains.
31491 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
31492 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
31493 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
31494 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
31495 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
31496 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
31497 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
31498 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
31499 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
31500 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
31501 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
31502 example, consider this router:
31507 file = $home/.forward
31508 local_part_suffix = -*
31509 local_part_suffix_optional
31512 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
31513 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
31514 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
31515 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
31517 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
31518 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
31521 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
31522 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
31523 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
31524 control over which suffixes are valid.
31526 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
31527 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
31533 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
31534 local_part_suffix = -*
31535 local_part_suffix_optional
31538 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
31539 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
31540 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
31541 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
31542 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
31546 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
31547 .cindex "vacation processing"
31548 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
31549 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
31550 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
31551 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
31552 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
31555 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
31556 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
31557 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
31558 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
31560 spqr, vacation-spqr
31563 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
31564 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
31565 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
31566 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
31567 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
31571 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
31572 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
31576 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
31577 .cindex "message" "copying every"
31578 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
31579 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
31580 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
31581 each day's messages.
31583 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
31584 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
31585 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
31586 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
31590 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
31591 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
31592 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
31593 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
31594 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
31595 permanently connected.
31597 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
31598 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
31599 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
31602 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
31603 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
31604 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
31605 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
31606 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
31607 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
31608 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
31609 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
31611 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
31612 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
31613 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
31614 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
31615 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
31616 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
31619 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
31620 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
31621 intermittent host. For example:
31623 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
31625 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
31626 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
31627 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
31628 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
31629 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
31630 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
31633 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
31634 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
31635 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
31636 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
31637 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
31638 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
31639 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
31643 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
31644 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
31645 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
31646 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
31647 delivered immediately.
31649 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31650 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
31651 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
31652 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
31653 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
31654 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
31655 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
31656 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
31657 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
31658 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
31659 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
31660 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
31661 single SMTP connection.
31665 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31666 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31668 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
31669 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
31670 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
31671 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
31672 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
31673 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
31674 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
31675 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
31676 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
31677 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
31680 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
31681 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
31682 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
31683 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
31684 email is not desirable.
31686 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
31687 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
31688 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
31689 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
31690 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
31691 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
31692 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
31694 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
31695 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
31696 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
31697 before sending a message to the smart host.
31699 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
31700 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
31701 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
31703 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
31704 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
31705 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
31706 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
31707 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
31708 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
31709 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
31711 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
31715 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
31716 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
31718 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
31719 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
31720 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
31721 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
31722 successful, a zero return code is given.
31724 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
31725 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
31726 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
31727 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
31728 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
31731 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
31732 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
31733 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
31735 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
31736 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
31737 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
31738 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
31739 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
31741 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
31742 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
31743 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
31745 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
31746 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
31747 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
31748 are ever generated.
31750 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
31752 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
31753 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
31754 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
31757 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
31758 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
31759 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
31760 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
31761 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
31762 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
31767 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31768 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31770 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
31771 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
31772 .cindex "log" "types of"
31773 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
31778 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
31779 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
31780 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
31781 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
31782 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
31783 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
31784 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
31785 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
31787 .cindex "reject log"
31788 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
31789 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
31790 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
31791 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
31792 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
31793 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
31794 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
31795 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
31796 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
31799 .cindex "panic log"
31800 .cindex "system log"
31801 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
31802 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
31803 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
31804 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
31805 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
31806 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
31807 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
31808 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
31809 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
31812 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
31813 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
31814 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
31816 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
31819 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
31820 ways of changing this:
31823 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
31828 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
31830 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
31833 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
31837 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
31838 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
31839 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
31840 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
31841 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
31842 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
31847 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
31848 .cindex "log" "destination"
31849 .cindex "log" "to file"
31850 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
31852 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
31853 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
31854 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
31855 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
31856 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
31857 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
31858 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
31860 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
31861 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
31862 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
31863 references to the host name:
31865 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
31867 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
31868 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
31869 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
31870 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
31871 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
31874 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
31875 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
31876 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
31877 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
31878 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
31879 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
31880 implying the use of a default path.
31882 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
31883 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
31884 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
31885 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
31886 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
31887 equivalent to the setting:
31889 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
31891 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
31894 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& if datestamped log file names are in
31895 use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
31897 Here are some examples of possible settings:
31899 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
31900 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
31901 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
31902 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
31904 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
31909 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
31910 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
31911 .cindex "cycling logs"
31912 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
31913 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
31914 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
31915 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
31916 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
31917 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
31918 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
31920 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
31921 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
31922 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
31923 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
31924 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
31925 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
31926 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
31927 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
31928 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
31929 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
31930 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
31935 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
31936 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
31937 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
31938 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
31939 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_&.
31940 Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting the
31941 &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& at the point where the
31942 datestamp is required. For example:
31944 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
31945 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
31946 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
31948 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
31949 examples of names generated by the above examples:
31951 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
31952 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
31953 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
31955 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
31956 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
31957 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
31958 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
31960 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
31961 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
31962 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& is removed from the string.
31963 In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following non-alphanumeric
31964 character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric character is
31965 removed. Thus, the three examples above would give these panic log names:
31967 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31968 /var/log/exim-panic.log
31969 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31973 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
31974 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
31975 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
31976 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
31977 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
31978 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
31979 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
31980 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
31981 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
31982 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
31983 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
31984 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
31985 the time and host name to each line.
31986 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
31989 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
31991 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
31993 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
31996 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
31997 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
31998 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
31999 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
32001 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
32002 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
32003 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
32004 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
32005 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
32006 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
32007 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
32008 RFC 3164, you should set
32010 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
32012 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
32013 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
32015 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
32016 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
32017 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
32018 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
32019 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
32020 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
32021 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
32022 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
32023 name, and pid as added by syslog:
32025 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
32026 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
32027 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
32028 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
32031 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
32034 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
32035 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
32036 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
32037 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
32039 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
32040 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
32041 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
32042 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
32043 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
32044 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
32046 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
32047 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
32048 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
32051 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
32053 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
32054 without modification.
32056 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
32057 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
32058 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
32063 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
32064 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
32065 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
32066 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
32067 timestamp. The flags are:
32069 &`<=`& message arrival
32070 &`=>`& normal message delivery
32071 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
32072 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
32073 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
32074 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
32078 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
32079 .cindex "log" "reception line"
32080 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
32081 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
32082 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
32084 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
32085 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
32086 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
32088 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
32089 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
32090 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
32094 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
32098 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
32099 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
32100 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
32101 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
32102 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
32103 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
32104 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
32105 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
32106 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
32107 name in parentheses.
32109 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
32110 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
32111 the log containing text like these examples:
32113 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
32114 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
32116 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
32119 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
32120 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
32123 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
32124 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
32125 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
32126 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
32127 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
32128 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
32129 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
32130 suite that was used.
32132 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
32133 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
32134 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
32135 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
32136 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
32137 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
32138 authenticator name.
32140 .cindex "size" "of message"
32141 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
32142 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
32143 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
32144 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
32147 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32148 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32152 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
32153 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
32154 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
32155 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
32156 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
32157 to fit it on the page:
32159 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
32160 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
32161 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
32162 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
32163 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
32165 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
32166 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
32167 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
32168 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
32169 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
32171 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
32172 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
32174 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
32176 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
32177 parentheses afterwards.
32179 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32180 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
32181 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
32182 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
32183 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
32184 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
32186 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
32187 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
32189 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32190 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32193 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
32194 .cindex "discarded messages"
32195 .cindex "message" "discarded"
32196 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
32197 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
32198 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
32200 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
32201 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
32203 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
32204 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
32206 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
32207 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
32211 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
32212 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
32214 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
32215 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
32217 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
32218 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
32219 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
32221 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
32222 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
32224 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
32225 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
32226 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
32230 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
32231 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
32232 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
32233 following form is logged:
32235 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
32236 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
32238 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
32239 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
32241 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
32242 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
32243 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
32244 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
32245 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
32247 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
32248 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
32249 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
32250 flagged with &`**`&.
32254 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
32255 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
32256 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
32257 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
32258 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
32262 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
32265 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
32267 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
32268 at the end of its processing.
32273 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
32274 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
32275 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
32276 the following table:
32278 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
32279 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
32280 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32281 &`CV `& certificate verification status
32282 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32283 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
32284 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
32285 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
32286 &`H `& host name and IP address
32287 &`I `& local interface used
32288 &`id `& message id for incoming message
32289 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
32290 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
32291 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
32292 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
32293 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
32294 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
32295 &`S `& size of message
32296 &`ST `& shadow transport name
32297 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
32298 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
32299 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
32300 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
32304 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
32305 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
32306 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
32309 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
32310 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
32311 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
32312 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
32313 during the first delivery attempt.
32315 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
32316 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
32317 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
32319 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
32320 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
32321 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
32322 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
32323 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
32326 .cindex "error" "ignored"
32327 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
32330 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
32331 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
32333 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
32334 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32336 A delivery set up by a router configured with
32337 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
32338 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
32342 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32350 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
32351 .cindex "log" "selectors"
32352 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
32353 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
32354 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
32357 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
32359 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
32360 selection marked by asterisks:
32362 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
32363 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
32364 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
32365 &` arguments `& command line arguments
32366 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
32367 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
32368 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
32369 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
32370 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
32371 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
32372 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
32373 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
32374 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
32375 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
32376 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
32377 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
32378 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
32379 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
32380 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
32381 &` pid `& Exim process id
32382 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
32383 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
32384 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
32385 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
32386 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
32387 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
32388 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
32389 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
32390 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
32391 &` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
32392 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
32393 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
32394 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
32395 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
32396 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
32397 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
32398 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
32399 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
32400 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
32401 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
32403 &` all `& all of the above
32405 More details on each of these items follows:
32408 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
32409 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
32410 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
32411 this log selector is set.
32413 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
32414 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
32415 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
32416 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
32417 such users cannot access the log).
32419 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
32420 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
32421 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
32422 parentheses between them.
32424 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
32425 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
32426 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
32427 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
32428 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
32429 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
32430 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
32431 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
32432 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
32433 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
32434 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
32435 between the caller and Exim.
32437 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
32438 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
32439 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
32441 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
32442 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
32443 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
32444 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
32445 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
32446 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
32448 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
32449 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
32450 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
32452 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
32453 .cindex "size" "of message"
32454 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
32455 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
32457 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
32458 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
32459 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32460 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
32461 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
32463 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
32464 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
32465 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
32466 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
32467 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
32468 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
32470 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
32471 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
32472 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
32473 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
32474 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
32476 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
32477 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
32478 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
32479 client's ident port times out.
32481 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
32482 .cindex "interface" "logging"
32483 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
32484 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
32485 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
32486 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
32489 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
32490 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
32491 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
32492 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
32493 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
32494 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
32495 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
32496 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
32497 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
32498 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
32499 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
32501 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
32502 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
32503 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
32505 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
32506 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
32507 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
32508 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
32509 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
32510 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
32511 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
32513 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
32514 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32515 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
32516 immediately after the time and date.
32518 .cindex "log" "queue run"
32519 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
32520 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
32522 .cindex "log" "queue time"
32523 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
32524 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
32525 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
32526 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
32527 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
32528 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
32529 message has been successfully received.
32531 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
32532 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
32533 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
32534 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
32536 .cindex "log" "recipients"
32537 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
32538 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
32539 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
32540 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
32542 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
32545 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
32546 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
32547 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
32548 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
32550 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
32551 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
32552 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
32553 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
32554 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
32556 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
32557 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
32558 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
32559 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
32562 .cindex "log" "return path"
32563 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
32564 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
32565 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
32566 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
32568 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
32569 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
32570 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
32571 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
32572 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
32574 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
32575 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
32576 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
32577 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
32580 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
32581 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
32584 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
32585 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
32586 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
32587 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
32589 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
32590 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
32592 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
32593 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
32594 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
32595 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
32596 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
32599 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
32600 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
32601 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
32602 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
32603 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
32604 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
32605 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
32606 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
32607 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
32608 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
32610 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
32611 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
32612 reset if the daemon is restarted.
32613 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
32614 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
32615 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
32616 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
32617 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
32619 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
32620 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
32621 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
32622 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
32623 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
32624 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
32626 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
32627 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
32628 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
32629 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
32630 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
32631 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
32632 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
32633 already have their own log lines.
32635 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
32636 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
32637 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
32638 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
32639 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
32640 the same logging options.
32642 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
32643 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
32647 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
32648 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
32649 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
32650 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
32651 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
32653 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
32654 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
32655 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
32656 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
32657 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
32658 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
32659 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
32660 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
32662 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
32663 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
32664 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
32665 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
32666 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
32667 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
32668 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
32669 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
32670 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
32672 .cindex "log" "subject"
32673 .cindex "subject, logging"
32674 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
32675 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
32676 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
32677 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
32678 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
32680 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
32681 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
32682 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
32683 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
32685 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
32686 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
32687 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32688 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
32690 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
32691 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
32692 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32693 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
32694 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
32696 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
32697 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
32698 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
32702 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
32703 .cindex "message" "log file for"
32704 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
32705 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
32706 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
32707 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
32708 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
32709 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
32710 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
32711 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
32712 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
32713 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
32714 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
32716 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
32717 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
32718 &%message_logs%& option false.
32724 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32725 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32727 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
32728 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
32729 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
32730 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
32731 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
32733 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
32734 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
32735 "list what Exim processes are doing"
32736 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
32737 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
32738 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
32739 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
32741 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
32742 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
32743 "extract statistics from the log"
32744 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
32745 "check address acceptance from given IP"
32746 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
32747 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
32748 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
32749 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
32750 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
32751 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
32754 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
32755 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
32756 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
32761 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
32762 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
32763 .cindex "process, querying"
32765 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
32766 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
32767 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
32768 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
32769 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
32770 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
32771 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
32772 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
32774 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
32775 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
32776 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
32779 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
32780 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
32781 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
32782 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
32783 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
32786 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
32787 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
32788 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
32789 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
32791 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
32793 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
32794 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
32795 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
32796 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
32797 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
32798 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
32800 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
32801 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
32805 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
32806 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
32807 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
32808 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
32812 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
32813 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
32814 options are available:
32817 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
32818 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
32819 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
32823 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
32824 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
32827 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
32828 Match against the size field.
32830 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32831 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
32833 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32834 Match messages that are older than the given time.
32837 Match only frozen messages.
32840 Match only non-frozen messages.
32843 The following options control the format of the output:
32847 Display only the count of matching messages.
32850 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
32854 Display message ids only.
32857 Brief format &-- one line per message.
32860 Display messages in reverse order.
32863 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
32867 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
32868 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
32869 .cindex "queue" "summary"
32870 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
32871 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
32872 running a command such as
32874 exim -bp | exiqsumm
32876 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
32877 it, as in the following example:
32879 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
32881 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
32882 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
32883 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
32884 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
32886 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
32887 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
32888 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
32889 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
32890 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
32891 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
32894 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
32895 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
32896 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
32897 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
32898 level"& addresses).
32903 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
32905 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
32906 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
32907 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
32908 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
32909 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
32910 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
32911 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
32912 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
32913 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
32914 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
32916 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
32918 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
32920 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
32921 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
32922 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
32924 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
32925 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
32926 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
32927 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
32928 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
32930 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
32931 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
32932 regular expression.
32934 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
32935 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
32937 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
32938 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
32939 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
32942 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
32943 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
32944 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
32945 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
32946 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
32947 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
32948 the &%--help%& option.
32951 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
32952 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
32953 .cindex "cycling logs"
32954 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
32955 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
32956 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
32957 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
32958 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
32959 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
32960 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
32962 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
32963 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
32965 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
32966 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
32967 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
32971 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
32972 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
32973 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
32974 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
32975 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
32976 logs are handled similarly.
32978 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
32979 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
32980 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
32981 any existing log files.
32983 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
32984 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
32985 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
32986 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
32987 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
32989 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
32991 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
32992 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
32996 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
32997 .cindex "statistics"
32998 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
32999 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
33000 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
33001 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
33002 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
33004 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
33005 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
33006 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
33007 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
33008 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
33010 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
33012 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
33013 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
33014 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
33015 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
33016 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
33017 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
33018 also produced per user.
33020 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
33021 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
33022 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
33023 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
33024 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
33026 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
33027 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
33028 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
33029 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
33030 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
33031 an entirely separate message.
33033 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
33034 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
33035 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
33036 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
33037 least one address that failed.
33039 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
33040 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
33041 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
33042 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
33043 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
33044 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
33045 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
33047 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
33048 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
33049 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
33051 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
33052 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
33053 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
33055 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
33058 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
33059 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
33060 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
33061 .cindex "checking access"
33062 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
33063 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
33064 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
33065 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
33066 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
33067 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
33069 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
33070 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
33072 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
33074 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
33075 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
33076 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
33077 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
33080 550 Relay not permitted
33082 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
33083 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
33084 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
33085 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
33088 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
33089 -f himself@there.example
33091 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
33092 mandatory arguments.
33094 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
33095 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
33096 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
33100 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
33101 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
33102 .cindex "building DBM files"
33103 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
33104 .cindex "lower casing"
33105 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
33106 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
33107 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
33108 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
33109 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
33110 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
33112 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
33113 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
33114 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
33115 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
33118 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
33119 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
33120 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
33124 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
33125 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
33126 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
33127 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
33129 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
33131 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
33132 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
33134 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
33135 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
33136 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
33137 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
33138 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
33139 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
33141 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
33142 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
33143 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
33144 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
33145 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
33146 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
33147 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
33153 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
33154 .cindex "retry" "times"
33155 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
33156 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
33157 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
33158 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
33159 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
33160 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
33161 output. For example:
33163 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
33164 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
33165 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33166 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33167 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
33168 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
33169 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
33170 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
33171 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
33172 past final cutoff time
33174 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
33175 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
33176 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
33177 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
33178 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
33179 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
33182 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
33183 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
33184 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
33185 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
33186 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
33187 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
33191 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
33192 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
33193 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
33194 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
33195 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
33196 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
33197 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
33200 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
33202 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
33205 &'callout'&: the callout cache
33207 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
33209 &'misc'&: other hints data
33212 The &'misc'& database is used for
33215 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
33217 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
33218 &(smtp)& transport)
33223 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
33224 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
33225 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
33226 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
33227 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
33229 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
33231 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
33233 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
33234 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
33236 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
33237 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
33238 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
33239 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
33240 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
33241 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
33242 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
33243 and a textual description of the error.
33245 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
33246 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
33247 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
33250 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
33251 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
33252 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
33253 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
33254 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
33255 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
33260 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
33261 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
33262 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
33263 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
33264 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
33265 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
33266 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
33267 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
33268 updated sufficiently often.
33270 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
33271 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
33272 the retry database:
33274 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
33276 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
33277 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
33278 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
33279 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
33280 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
33281 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
33282 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
33283 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
33284 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
33285 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
33286 whenever it removes information from the database.
33288 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
33289 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
33290 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
33291 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
33292 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
33294 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
33295 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
33296 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
33297 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
33298 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
33299 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
33300 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
33303 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
33304 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
33309 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
33310 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
33311 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
33312 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
33313 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
33314 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
33315 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
33318 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
33319 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
33320 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
33321 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
33322 by new data, for example:
33326 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
33327 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
33328 used as optional separators.
33333 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
33334 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
33335 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
33336 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
33337 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
33338 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
33339 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
33340 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
33341 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
33342 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
33343 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
33344 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
33345 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
33349 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
33352 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
33355 .vitem &%-interval%&
33356 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
33357 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
33359 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
33360 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
33363 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
33366 Suppress verification output.
33368 .vitem &%-retries%&
33369 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
33370 the lock (default 10).
33372 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
33373 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
33374 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
33375 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
33378 .vitem &%-timeout%&
33379 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
33380 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
33381 default), a non-blocking call is used.
33384 Generate verbose output.
33387 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
33388 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
33389 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
33390 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
33391 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
33392 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
33393 more than 30 minutes old.
33395 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
33396 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
33397 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
33398 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
33399 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
33400 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
33402 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
33403 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
33404 suppresses all output except error messages.
33408 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
33410 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
33412 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
33413 <&'some commands'&>
33416 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
33417 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
33420 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
33421 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
33423 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
33424 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
33428 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33429 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33431 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
33432 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
33433 .cindex "X-windows"
33434 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
33435 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
33436 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
33437 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
33438 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
33439 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
33440 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
33441 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
33445 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
33446 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
33447 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
33448 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
33449 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
33450 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
33451 parameters are for.
33453 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
33454 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
33455 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
33457 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
33459 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
33460 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
33461 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
33462 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
33463 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
33465 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
33466 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
33468 Eximon*background: gray94
33470 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
33471 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
33472 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
33473 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
33474 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
33475 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
33476 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
33479 Eximon*highlight: gray
33482 .cindex "admin user"
33483 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
33484 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
33486 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
33487 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
33488 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
33489 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
33490 different parts of the display.
33495 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
33496 .cindex "stripchart"
33497 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
33498 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33499 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
33500 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
33501 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
33502 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
33503 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
33504 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
33505 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33507 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
33508 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
33509 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
33510 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
33512 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
33513 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
33514 to a single partition.
33516 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
33517 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
33518 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
33519 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
33520 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
33521 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33522 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33527 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
33528 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
33529 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
33530 .cindex "window size"
33531 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
33532 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
33533 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
33534 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
33535 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
33536 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
33538 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
33539 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
33540 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
33541 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
33543 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
33544 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
33545 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
33546 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
33547 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
33548 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33550 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
33551 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
33552 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33556 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
33557 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
33558 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
33559 the main log is maintained.
33560 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
33561 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
33562 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
33563 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
33564 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
33566 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
33567 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
33568 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
33569 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
33570 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
33571 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
33572 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
33573 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
33574 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
33575 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
33576 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33578 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
33579 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
33580 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
33581 It cannot go further back up the log.
33583 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
33584 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
33585 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
33586 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
33587 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
33588 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
33590 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
33591 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
33592 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
33593 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
33594 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
33595 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
33597 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
33598 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
33599 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
33600 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
33601 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
33602 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
33603 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
33604 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
33605 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
33610 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
33611 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
33612 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
33613 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
33614 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
33615 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
33616 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
33617 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
33618 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
33619 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
33621 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
33622 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
33623 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
33624 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
33625 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
33626 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
33627 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
33629 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
33630 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
33631 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
33632 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
33633 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
33634 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
33635 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
33637 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
33638 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
33639 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
33640 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
33642 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
33643 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
33644 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
33645 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
33646 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
33647 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
33648 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
33651 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
33652 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
33654 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
33655 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
33656 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
33657 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
33658 display is updated.
33662 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
33663 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
33664 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
33665 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
33666 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
33669 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
33670 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
33671 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
33672 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
33673 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
33675 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
33677 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
33681 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
33682 in a new text window.
33684 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
33685 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
33686 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
33688 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
33689 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
33690 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
33691 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
33693 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
33694 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
33695 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
33696 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
33697 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
33699 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
33700 that the message be frozen.
33702 .cindex "thawing messages"
33703 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
33704 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
33705 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
33706 that the message be thawed.
33708 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
33709 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
33710 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
33711 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
33713 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
33714 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
33717 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
33718 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33719 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33720 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33721 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
33722 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
33723 which case no action is taken.
33725 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
33726 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33727 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33728 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33729 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
33730 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
33731 case no action is taken.
33733 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
33734 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
33736 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
33737 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
33738 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
33739 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
33740 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
33741 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
33742 the address is qualified with that domain.
33745 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
33746 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
33747 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
33748 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
33749 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
33750 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
33751 if no output is generated.
33753 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
33754 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
33755 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
33756 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
33758 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
33759 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
33760 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
33767 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33768 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33770 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
33771 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
33772 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
33773 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
33775 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
33776 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
33777 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
33778 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
33779 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
33780 its security as compared with other MTAs.
33782 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
33783 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
33784 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
33785 as soon as possible.
33788 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
33789 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
33790 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
33791 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
33792 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
33793 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
33796 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
33797 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
33798 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
33799 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
33800 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
33801 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
33803 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
33804 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
33805 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
33806 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
33808 If ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined, root privilege is retained for &%-C%&
33809 and &%-D%& only if the caller of Exim is root. Without it, the Exim user may
33810 also use &%-C%& and &%-D%& and retain privilege. Setting this option locks out
33811 the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message
33812 reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by
33813 that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain
33814 privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost.
33815 However, root can test reception and delivery using two separate commands.
33816 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is not set by default.
33818 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
33821 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
33822 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
33823 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
33824 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
33825 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
33831 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
33833 .cindex "root privilege"
33834 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
33835 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
33836 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
33837 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
33838 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
33839 is required for two things:
33842 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
33843 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
33846 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
33847 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
33851 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
33852 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
33853 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
33854 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
33855 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
33856 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
33857 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
33858 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
33860 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
33861 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
33862 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
33864 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
33865 uid and gid in the following cases:
33870 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
33871 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
33872 calling process is not running as root or the Exim user, the uid and gid are
33873 changed to those of the calling process.
33874 However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, only
33875 root callers may use &%-C%& and &%-D%& without losing privilege, and if
33876 DISABLE_D_OPTION is set, the &%-D%& option may not be used at all.
33881 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
33882 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
33885 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
33886 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
33887 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
33888 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
33889 testing address verification
33892 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
33895 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
33896 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
33899 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
33902 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
33903 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
33904 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
33905 will be used during message reception.
33907 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
33908 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
33910 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
33911 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
33912 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
33913 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
33914 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
33915 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
33916 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
33917 generating bounce and warning messages.
33919 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
33920 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
33921 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
33922 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
33924 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
33925 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
33931 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
33932 .cindex "privilege, running without"
33933 .cindex "unprivileged running"
33934 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
33935 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
33936 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
33937 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
33938 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
33939 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
33940 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
33944 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
33945 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
33946 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
33947 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
33949 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
33950 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
33951 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
33952 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
33953 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
33955 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
33956 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
33957 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
33960 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
33961 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
33962 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
33964 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
33965 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
33966 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
33967 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
33968 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
33969 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
33970 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
33971 address this problem at this time.
33973 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
33974 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
33975 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
33976 be used in the most straightforward way.
33978 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
33979 number of restrictions on what you can do:
33982 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
33983 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
33984 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
33985 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
33986 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
33988 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
33989 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
33991 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
33992 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
33993 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
33994 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
33996 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
33997 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
34000 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
34001 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
34002 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
34004 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
34005 owned by the Exim user.
34007 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
34008 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
34009 mailboxes need to be created manually.
34014 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
34015 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
34016 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
34017 gives more security at essentially no cost.
34019 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
34020 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
34025 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
34026 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
34027 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
34031 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
34032 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
34033 .cindex "IP source routing"
34034 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
34035 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
34036 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
34037 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
34041 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
34042 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
34043 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
34048 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
34049 .cindex "trusted users"
34050 .cindex "admin user"
34051 .cindex "privileged user"
34052 .cindex "user" "trusted"
34053 .cindex "user" "admin"
34054 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
34055 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
34056 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
34057 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
34058 permit a remote host to be specified.
34061 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
34062 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
34063 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
34064 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
34065 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
34066 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
34068 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
34069 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
34070 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
34071 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
34072 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
34074 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
34075 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
34076 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
34077 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
34078 includes the contents of files on the spool.
34082 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
34083 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
34084 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
34085 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
34086 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
34087 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
34089 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
34090 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
34091 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
34092 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
34093 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
34094 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
34099 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
34100 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
34101 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
34102 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
34103 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
34104 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
34108 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
34109 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
34110 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
34111 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
34112 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
34117 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
34118 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
34119 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
34120 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
34125 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
34126 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
34127 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
34128 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
34129 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
34133 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
34134 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
34135 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
34136 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
34137 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
34138 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
34139 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
34141 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
34142 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
34147 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
34148 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
34149 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
34150 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
34154 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
34155 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
34156 enough to hold the result.
34157 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
34162 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34165 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
34166 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
34167 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
34168 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
34169 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
34170 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
34171 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
34172 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
34173 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
34174 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
34175 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
34176 themselves are recoverable.
34178 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
34179 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
34180 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
34183 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
34184 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
34185 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
34186 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
34187 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
34189 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
34190 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
34191 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
34192 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
34193 will always be the case.
34195 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
34197 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
34200 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
34202 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
34203 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
34204 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
34205 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
34206 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
34207 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
34208 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
34209 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
34212 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
34213 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
34214 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
34215 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
34216 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
34217 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
34218 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
34219 normally the Exim user.
34221 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
34222 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
34223 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
34224 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
34225 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
34226 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
34227 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
34228 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
34230 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
34231 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
34232 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
34233 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
34235 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
34236 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
34239 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34240 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
34241 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
34242 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
34243 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
34244 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
34245 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
34246 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
34247 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
34250 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34251 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
34252 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
34253 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34254 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34255 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34257 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34258 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
34259 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
34260 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34261 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34262 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34264 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
34265 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
34266 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
34268 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
34269 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
34270 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
34271 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
34272 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34274 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
34275 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
34276 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
34277 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
34278 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34280 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
34281 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
34282 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
34284 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
34285 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
34286 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
34288 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34289 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
34292 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34293 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
34294 present if the number is greater than zero.
34296 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
34297 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
34298 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
34300 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
34301 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
34302 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
34304 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34305 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
34308 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34309 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
34310 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
34313 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
34314 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
34315 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
34316 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
34318 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
34319 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
34320 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
34322 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34323 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
34324 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
34325 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
34326 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
34327 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
34329 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
34330 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
34331 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
34332 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
34333 supplied by the remote host, if any.
34335 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34336 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
34337 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
34338 generated messages.
34341 The message is from a local sender.
34343 .vitem &%-localerror%&
34344 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
34346 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
34347 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
34348 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
34349 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
34351 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
34352 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
34353 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
34356 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
34357 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
34360 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
34361 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
34362 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34364 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
34365 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
34366 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
34368 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
34369 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
34370 of &$spam_score_int$&.
34372 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
34373 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
34374 certificate was verified by the server.
34376 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
34377 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
34378 name of the cipher suite that was used.
34380 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
34381 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
34382 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
34386 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
34387 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
34388 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
34389 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
34390 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
34391 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
34392 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
34393 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
34394 addresses are complete.
34396 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
34397 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
34398 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
34399 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
34400 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
34401 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
34403 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
34404 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
34405 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34407 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
34408 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
34409 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
34410 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
34414 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34415 darcy@austen.fict.example
34417 alice@wonderland.fict.example
34419 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
34420 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
34421 line is of the following form:
34423 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
34424 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
34426 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
34427 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
34428 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
34429 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
34430 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
34431 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
34432 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
34433 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
34436 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
34437 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
34438 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
34439 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
34440 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
34444 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
34445 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
34446 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
34447 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
34448 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
34449 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
34450 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
34451 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
34452 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
34453 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
34456 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
34457 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
34458 typical set of headers:
34460 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
34461 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34462 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
34463 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
34464 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
34465 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
34466 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
34467 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34468 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
34469 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34470 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34472 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
34473 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
34474 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
34475 .ecindex IIDforspo1
34476 .ecindex IIDforspo2
34477 .ecindex IIDforspo3
34479 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34480 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34482 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail) - RFC4871" "CHID12" &&&
34486 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
34487 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
34489 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
34491 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
34492 It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
34494 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
34495 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
34496 different signature contexts.
34499 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
34500 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
34501 Exim's standard controls.
34503 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
34504 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
34505 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
34506 signature status. Here is an example:
34508 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM: d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
34510 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
34511 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
34512 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
34513 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
34517 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
34518 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
34520 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
34521 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
34523 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
34525 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
34526 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
34528 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
34530 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
34531 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
34532 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
34533 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
34535 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
34537 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
34538 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
34539 The result can either
34541 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
34543 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
34546 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
34547 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
34551 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
34553 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
34554 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
34555 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
34556 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
34558 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
34560 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
34561 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
34562 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
34563 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
34566 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
34568 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
34569 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
34570 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
34574 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
34575 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
34577 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
34578 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
34579 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
34581 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
34582 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
34583 runtime of the ACL.
34585 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
34586 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
34587 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
34588 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
34590 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
34591 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
34592 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
34593 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
34594 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
34595 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
34598 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
34600 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
34601 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
34602 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
34604 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
34606 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
34607 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
34608 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
34610 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
34613 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
34614 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
34617 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
34618 available (from most to least important):
34621 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
34622 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
34623 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
34624 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
34625 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
34626 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
34628 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
34629 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34631 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
34632 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
34634 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
34635 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
34637 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
34639 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
34640 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
34641 "fail" or "invalid". One of
34643 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
34644 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
34646 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
34647 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
34649 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
34650 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
34651 means that the message body was modified in transit.
34653 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
34654 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
34655 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
34656 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
34658 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
34659 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
34660 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
34661 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34662 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
34663 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
34664 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
34665 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34666 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
34667 The key record selector string.
34668 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
34669 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
34670 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
34671 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
34672 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
34673 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
34674 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
34675 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
34676 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
34677 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
34678 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
34679 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
34680 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
34681 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
34682 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
34683 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
34684 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
34685 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
34686 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
34687 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
34688 integer size comparisons against this value.
34689 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
34690 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
34691 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
34692 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
34693 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomaining%&
34694 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
34695 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
34696 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
34698 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
34699 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
34701 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
34702 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
34705 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
34708 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
34709 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
34710 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
34711 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
34712 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
34715 # Warn when message apparently from GMail has no signature at all
34716 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
34717 sender_domains = gmail.com
34718 dkim_signers = gmail.com
34722 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
34723 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
34724 results agains the actual result of verification. This is typically used
34725 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, like:
34728 deny message = Message from Paypal with invalid or missing signature
34729 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
34730 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
34731 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
34734 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
34735 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
34736 for more information of what they mean.
34739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34742 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
34743 "Adding drivers or lookups"
34744 .cindex "adding drivers"
34745 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
34746 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
34747 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
34748 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
34751 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
34752 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
34754 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
34756 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
34758 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
34759 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
34760 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
34762 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
34764 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
34767 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
34768 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
34770 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
34771 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
34772 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
34774 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
34777 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
34778 as for other drivers and lookups.
34781 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
34782 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
34783 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
34784 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
34785 searched using a binary chop procedure.
34787 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
34788 the interface that is expected.
34793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34794 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34796 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34797 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
34798 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
34799 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
34801 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34806 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
34807 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
34811 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
34812 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
34813 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
34816 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34817 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////